blob: 103c7e191cc724fa21dd189498d7b1ec8362a3f2 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Chandler Carruthaa36b892015-12-30 03:40:23 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000024#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000025#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000027#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000028#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000029#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000030#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000031#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000032#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000033#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000034#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000035#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000036#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000037#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000038#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000039#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000040#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000041#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000042#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000043
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000044using namespace clang;
45
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000054unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000056unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000059enum FloatingRank {
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +000060 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank, Float128Rank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000061};
62
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000063RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000064 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +000066
67#ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71#endif
72
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000073 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000078 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000080 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000081
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000082 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000085 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000086 }
87
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000088 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000091 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000092 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +000096 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000097 }
98
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000099 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000104 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000105 }
106
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000109 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000110 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000115 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000116 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000119 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000120
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000126 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000127
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000132 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000133
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000146 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000165 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000166
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000170 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000217 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000224 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000229 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000238 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000245 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000254 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000255
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000257}
258
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000259namespace {
260/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000262/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000263const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000283 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000328 return D;
329}
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +0000330} // anonymous namespace
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000331
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000332const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000336
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000347 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000348 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000349 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000350
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000356 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000369 // Call order swapped to work around ICE in VS2015 RTM (Release Win32)
370 // https://connect.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/feedback/details/1741530
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000371 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000372 Raw.setRaw(RC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000373 } else
374 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000375 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
376 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000377 if (RC)
378 break;
379 }
380 }
381
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000382 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
383 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000384
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000385 if (OriginalDecl)
386 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
387
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000388 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
389 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
390 Raw.setRaw(RC);
391 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000392 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000393
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000394 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
395 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000396 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
397 R = Raw;
398 }
399
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000400 return RC;
401}
402
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000403static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
404 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
405 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
406 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
407 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
408 if (!ID)
409 return;
410 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000411 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000412 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000413 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000414 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
415 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
416 }
417 }
418}
419
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000420comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
421 const Decl *D) const {
422 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
423 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
424 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
425 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
426 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000427 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
428 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000429 comments::FullComment *CFC =
430 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
431 ThisDeclInfo);
432 return CFC;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000433}
434
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000435comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
436 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000437 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000438}
439
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000440comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
441 const Decl *D,
442 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000443 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000444 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000445 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000446
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000447 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
448 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
449 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000450
451 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000452 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000453 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000454 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000455 return CFC;
456 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000457 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000458 }
459
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000460 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000461
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000462 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000463 if (!RC) {
464 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000465 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000466 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000467 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
468 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
469 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
470 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000471 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000472 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
473 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000474 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
475 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
476 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000477 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000478 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000479 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000480 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000481 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000482 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
483 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
484 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000485 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000486 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000487 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
488 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
489 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
490 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
491 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
492 }
493 }
494 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
495 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
496 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
497 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
498 }
499 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
500 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000501 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000502 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000503 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
504 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000505 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000506 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000507 if (Ty.isNull())
508 continue;
509 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
510 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
511 continue;
512
513 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
514 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
515 }
516 }
517 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000518 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
519 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000520 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000521 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000522 if (Ty.isNull())
523 continue;
524 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
525 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
526 continue;
527 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
528 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
529 }
530 }
531 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000532 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000533 }
534
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000535 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
536 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
537 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
538 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000539 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000540 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000541
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000542 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000543 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
544 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000545}
546
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000547void
548ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
549 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
551 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000552 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000553
554 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
555 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
556 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
557 PEnd = Params->end();
558 P != PEnd; ++P) {
559 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
560 ID.AddInteger(0);
561 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
562 continue;
563 }
564
565 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
566 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000567 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000568 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000569 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
570 ID.AddBoolean(true);
571 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000572 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
573 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
574 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
575 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000576 } else
577 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000578 continue;
579 }
580
581 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
582 ID.AddInteger(2);
583 Profile(ID, TTP);
584 }
585}
586
587TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
588ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000589 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000590 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
591 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
592 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000593 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000594 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
595 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
596 if (Canonical)
597 return Canonical->getParam();
598
599 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
600 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000601 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000602 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
603 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
604 PEnd = Params->end();
605 P != PEnd; ++P) {
606 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
607 CanonParams.push_back(
608 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000609 SourceLocation(),
610 SourceLocation(),
611 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000612 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000613 TTP->isParameterPack()));
614 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000615 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
616 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
617 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
618 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
619 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000620 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
621 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000622 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
623 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
624 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
625 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
626 }
627
628 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000629 SourceLocation(),
630 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000631 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000632 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000633 T,
634 TInfo,
David Majnemerdfecf1a2016-07-06 04:19:16 +0000635 ExpandedTypes,
636 ExpandedTInfos);
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000641 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000654 assert(!TTP->getRequiresClause() &&
655 "Unexpected requires-clause on template template-parameter");
George Burgess IVb7e4e482016-08-25 01:54:37 +0000656 Expr *const CanonRequiresClause = nullptr;
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000657
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000658 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
659 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
660 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000661 TTP->getPosition(),
662 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000663 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000664 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
665 SourceLocation(),
David Majnemer902f8c62015-12-27 07:16:27 +0000666 CanonParams,
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000667 SourceLocation(),
668 CanonRequiresClause));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000669
670 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
671 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000672 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000673 (void)Canonical;
674
675 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
676 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
677 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
678 return CanonTTP;
679}
680
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000681CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000682 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000683
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000684 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000686 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000687 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +0000688 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000689 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +0000690 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000691 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +0000692 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000693 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000694 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000695 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
696 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000697 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000698}
699
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000700static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000701 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
702 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
703 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
704 // language-specific address space.
705 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
706 1, // opencl_global
Egor Churaev28f00aa2016-12-23 16:11:25 +0000707 3, // opencl_local
708 2, // opencl_constant
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000709 4, // opencl_generic
710 5, // cuda_device
711 6, // cuda_constant
712 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000713 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000714 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000715 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000716 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000717 }
718}
719
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000720static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
721 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
722 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000723 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
724 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
725 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
726 return true;
727 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
728 return false;
729 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000730 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000731}
732
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000733ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000734 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000735 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000736 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
737 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
738 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
739 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +0000740 UInt128Decl(nullptr), BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr),
741 BuiltinMSVaListDecl(nullptr), ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr),
742 ObjCClassDecl(nullptr), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +0000743 CFConstantStringTagDecl(nullptr), CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr),
744 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr), FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
745 sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr), ucontext_tDecl(nullptr),
746 BlockDescriptorType(nullptr), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr),
747 cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr), FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Eric Fiselier6ad68552016-07-01 01:24:09 +0000748 ExternCContext(nullptr), MakeIntegerSeqDecl(nullptr),
749 TypePackElementDecl(nullptr), SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova511cdd2015-02-04 17:40:08 +0000750 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000751 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), AuxTarget(nullptr),
752 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
753 BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr),
754 Listener(nullptr), Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000755 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000756 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
757}
758
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000759ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000760 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
761
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000762 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
763 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
764 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000765
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000766 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000767 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
768 (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000769
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000770 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000771 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
772 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
773 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
774 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
775 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
776 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
777 R->Destroy(*this);
778
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000779 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
780 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
781 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
782 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
783 R->Destroy(*this);
784 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000785
786 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
787 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
788 A != AEnd; ++A)
789 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000790
David Majnemere694f3e2015-08-14 14:43:50 +0000791 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair :
792 MaterializedTemporaryValues)
793 MTVPair.second->~APValue();
794
Richard Smith423f46f2016-07-20 21:38:26 +0000795 for (const auto &Value : ModuleInitializers)
796 Value.second->~PerModuleInitializers();
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000797}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000798
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000799void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +0000800 if (!PointerParents) return;
801 for (const auto &Entry : *PointerParents) {
802 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
803 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
804 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
805 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
806 }
807 }
808 for (const auto &Entry : *OtherParents) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000809 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
810 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +0000811 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000812 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
813 }
814 }
815}
816
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000817void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000818 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000819}
820
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000821void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000822ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
Benjamin Kramerd6da1a02016-06-12 20:05:23 +0000823 ExternalSource = std::move(Source);
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000824}
825
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000826void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000827 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
828 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000829
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000830 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000831#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000832#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
833#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
834 0 // Extra
835 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000836
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000837 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
838 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000839 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000840 }
841
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000842 unsigned Idx = 0;
843 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
844#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
845 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000846 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
847 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000848 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
849 ++Idx;
850#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
851#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000852
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000853 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
854
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000855 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000856 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
857 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
858 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
859 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
860 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
861 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000862 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000863 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
864 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
865 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
866 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
867 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
868 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000869 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000870 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
871 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
872 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
873 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
874 << NumImplicitDestructors
875 << " implicit destructors created\n";
876
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000877 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000878 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000879 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
880 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000881
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000882 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000883}
884
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000885void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
886 bool NotifyListeners) {
887 if (NotifyListeners)
888 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
889 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
890
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000891 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
892 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
893 else
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000894 ND->setHidden(false);
895}
896
897void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
898 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
899 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
900 return;
901
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000902 auto &Merged = It->second;
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000903 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
904 for (Module *&M : Merged)
905 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
906 M = nullptr;
907 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
908}
909
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +0000910void ASTContext::PerModuleInitializers::resolve(ASTContext &Ctx) {
911 if (LazyInitializers.empty())
912 return;
913
914 auto *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
915 assert(Source && "lazy initializers but no external source");
916
917 auto LazyInits = std::move(LazyInitializers);
918 LazyInitializers.clear();
919
920 for (auto ID : LazyInits)
921 Initializers.push_back(Source->GetExternalDecl(ID));
922
923 assert(LazyInitializers.empty() &&
924 "GetExternalDecl for lazy module initializer added more inits");
925}
926
927void ASTContext::addModuleInitializer(Module *M, Decl *D) {
928 // One special case: if we add a module initializer that imports another
929 // module, and that module's only initializer is an ImportDecl, simplify.
930 if (auto *ID = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D)) {
931 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(ID->getImportedModule());
932
933 // Maybe the ImportDecl does nothing at all. (Common case.)
934 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
935 return;
936
937 // Maybe the ImportDecl only imports another ImportDecl.
938 auto &Imported = *It->second;
939 if (Imported.Initializers.size() + Imported.LazyInitializers.size() == 1) {
940 Imported.resolve(*this);
941 auto *OnlyDecl = Imported.Initializers.front();
942 if (isa<ImportDecl>(OnlyDecl))
943 D = OnlyDecl;
944 }
945 }
946
947 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
948 if (!Inits)
949 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
950 Inits->Initializers.push_back(D);
951}
952
953void ASTContext::addLazyModuleInitializers(Module *M, ArrayRef<uint32_t> IDs) {
954 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
955 if (!Inits)
956 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
957 Inits->LazyInitializers.insert(Inits->LazyInitializers.end(),
958 IDs.begin(), IDs.end());
959}
960
961ArrayRef<Decl*> ASTContext::getModuleInitializers(Module *M) {
962 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(M);
963 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
964 return None;
965
966 auto *Inits = It->second;
967 Inits->resolve(*this);
968 return Inits->Initializers;
969}
970
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +0000971ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
972 if (!ExternCContext)
973 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
974
975 return ExternCContext;
976}
977
David Majnemerd9b1a4f2015-11-04 03:40:30 +0000978BuiltinTemplateDecl *
979ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
980 const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
981 auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK);
982 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
983 TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
984
985 return BuiltinTemplate;
986}
987
988BuiltinTemplateDecl *
989ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
990 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
991 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
992 getMakeIntegerSeqName());
993 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
994}
995
Eric Fiselier6ad68552016-07-01 01:24:09 +0000996BuiltinTemplateDecl *
997ASTContext::getTypePackElementDecl() const {
998 if (!TypePackElementDecl)
999 TypePackElementDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__type_pack_element,
1000 getTypePackElementName());
1001 return TypePackElementDecl;
1002}
1003
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001004RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
1005 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001006 SourceLocation Loc;
1007 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001008 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1009 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
1010 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001011 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001012 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
1013 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001014 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +00001015 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
1016 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001017 return NewDecl;
1018}
1019
1020TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
1021 StringRef Name) const {
1022 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
1023 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
1024 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
1025 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
1026 NewDecl->setImplicit();
1027 return NewDecl;
1028}
1029
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001030TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001031 if (!Int128Decl)
1032 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001033 return Int128Decl;
1034}
1035
1036TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001037 if (!UInt128Decl)
1038 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001039 return UInt128Decl;
1040}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +00001041
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001042void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001043 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001044 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001045 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00001046}
1047
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001048void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
1049 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001050 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
1051 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001052 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001053
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001054 this->Target = &Target;
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001055 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
1056
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001057 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
1058 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +00001059 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001060
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001061 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001062 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001063
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001064 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001065 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001066 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +00001067 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +00001068 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
1069 else
1070 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001071 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001072 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
1073 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
1074 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
1075 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
1076 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001077
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001078 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001079 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
1080 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
1081 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
1082 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
1083 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001084
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001085 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001086 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
1087 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
1088 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001089
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001090 // GNU extension, __float128 for IEEE quadruple precision
1091 InitBuiltinType(Float128Ty, BuiltinType::Float128);
1092
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00001093 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1094 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
1095 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
1096
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +00001097 // C++ 3.9.1p5
1098 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1099 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1100 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1101 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1102 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1103 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1104 else {
1105 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1106 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1107 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001108
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +00001109 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1110
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001111 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1112 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1113 else // C99
1114 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1115
1116 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1117 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1118 else // C99
1119 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1120
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001121 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1122 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1123 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1124 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1125 // expressions.
1126 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001127
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00001128 // Placeholder type for functions.
1129 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1130
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001131 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1132 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1133
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001134 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1135 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1136
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001137 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1138 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1139
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001140 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1141 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1142
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001143 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1144 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1145
Alexey Bataev1a3320e2015-08-25 14:24:04 +00001146 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1147 if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
1148 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1149
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001150 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001151 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1152 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1153 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001154 Float128ComplexTy = getComplexType(Float128Ty);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001155
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001156 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001157 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1158 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001159 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001160
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00001161 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1162#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1163 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00001164#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001165
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001166 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001167 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001168 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1169 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001170 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001171 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001172
1173 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001174 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1175 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001176
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001177 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001178
1179 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001180
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001181 // void * type
1182 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001183
1184 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1185 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001186
1187 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1188 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001189
1190 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00001191 VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001192}
1193
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001194DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001195 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1196}
1197
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001198AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1199 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1200 if (!Result) {
1201 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1202 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1203 }
1204
1205 return *Result;
1206}
1207
1208/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1209void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1210 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1211 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1212 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1213 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1214 }
1215}
1216
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001217// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001218MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001219ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001220 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001221 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1222 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1223}
1224
1225ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1226ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1227 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1228 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1229 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1230 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001231
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001232 return Pos->second;
1233}
1234
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001235void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001236ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001237 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1238 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001239 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1240 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001241 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1242 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1243}
1244
1245void
1246ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1247 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1248 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1249 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1250 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001251}
1252
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001253FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1254 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1255 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1256 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001257 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1258 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001259 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001260
1261 return Pos->second;
1262}
1263
1264void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1265 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1266 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1267 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001268 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001269}
1270
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001271NamedDecl *
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001272ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *UUD) {
1273 auto Pos = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001274 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001275 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001276
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001277 return Pos->second;
1278}
1279
1280void
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001281ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001282 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1283 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1284 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1285 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001286 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Inst) ||
1287 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Inst) ||
1288 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Inst)) &&
1289 "instantiation did not produce a using decl");
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001290 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1291 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1292}
1293
1294UsingShadowDecl *
1295ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1296 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1297 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1298 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001299 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001300
1301 return Pos->second;
1302}
1303
1304void
1305ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1306 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1307 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1308 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001309}
1310
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001311FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1312 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1313 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1314 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001315 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001316
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001317 return Pos->second;
1318}
1319
1320void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1321 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1322 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1323 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1324 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1325 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001326
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001327 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1328}
1329
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001330ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1331ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001332 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1333 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001334 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001335 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001336 return Pos->second.begin();
1337}
1338
1339ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1340ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001341 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1342 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001343 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001344 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001345 return Pos->second.end();
1346}
1347
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001348unsigned
1349ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001350 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1351 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001352 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1353 return 0;
Chandler Carruthb1bcd5d2016-06-11 04:45:38 +00001354 return Pos->second.size();
Clement Courbet8251ebf2016-06-10 11:54:43 +00001355}
1356
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001357ASTContext::overridden_method_range
1358ASTContext::overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1359 return overridden_method_range(overridden_methods_begin(Method),
1360 overridden_methods_end(Method));
1361}
1362
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001363void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1364 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001365 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001366 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1367}
1368
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001369void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1370 const NamedDecl *D,
1371 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001372 assert(D);
1373
1374 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001375 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1376 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001377 return;
1378 }
1379
1380 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1381 if (!Method)
1382 return;
1383
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001384 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1385 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001386 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001387}
1388
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001389void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1390 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1391 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1392 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1393 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1394 LastLocalImport = Import;
1395 return;
1396 }
1397
1398 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1399 LastLocalImport = Import;
1400}
1401
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001402//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1403// Type Sizing and Analysis
1404//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001405
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001406/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1407/// scalar floating point type.
1408const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001409 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001410 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1411 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001412 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001413 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001414 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1415 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1416 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001417 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Target->getFloat128Format();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001418 }
1419}
1420
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001421CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001422 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001423
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001424 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1425 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1426 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001427
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001428 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1429 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1430 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1431 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001432 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001433 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1434 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1435 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1436 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1437 } else {
1438 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1439 }
1440 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001441 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1442 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1443 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1444 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001445
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001446 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1447 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001448 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001449 // do nothing
1450
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001451 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001452 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001453 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001454 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001455 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1456 else
1457 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1458 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001459 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
Akira Hatanakad62f2c82017-01-06 17:56:15 +00001460 if (T->isFunctionType())
1461 Align = getTypeInfoImpl(T.getTypePtr()).Align;
1462 else if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001463 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1464 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001465 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001466 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1467 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001468 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1469 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1470 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1471 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1472 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1473 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001474 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001475 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001476 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Ulrich Weigandb63f7792015-04-21 17:26:18 +00001477 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001478 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1479 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001480 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001481
1482 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1483 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1484 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1485 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1486 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001487 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1488 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1489 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1490 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1491 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001492
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001493 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1494 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001495
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001496 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1497 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1498 if (Offset > 0) {
1499 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1500 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1501 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1502 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1503 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1504 }
1505
1506 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001507 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001508 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001509 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001510
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001511 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001512}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001513
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001514// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1515// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1516// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1517// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1518std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1519ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1520 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1521
1522 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1523 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1524 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1525 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1526 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1527 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1528 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1529 }
1530 }
1531
1532 return sizeAndAlign;
1533}
1534
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001535/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1536/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1537std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1538static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1539 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1540 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1541 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1542 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001543 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1544 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001545 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1546 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1547 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001548 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1549 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001550 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001551 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1552 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1553}
1554
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001555std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001556ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001557 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1558 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001559 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1560 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1561 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001562}
1563
1564std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001565ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001566 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1567}
1568
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001569bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1570 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1571}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001572
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001573bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1574 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1575}
1576
Richard Smithb2f0f052016-10-10 18:54:32 +00001577unsigned ASTContext::getTypeAlignIfKnown(QualType T) const {
1578 // An alignment on a typedef overrides anything else.
1579 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1580 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1581 return Align;
1582
1583 // If we have an (array of) complete type, we're done.
1584 T = getBaseElementType(T);
1585 if (!T->isIncompleteType())
1586 return getTypeAlign(T);
1587
1588 // If we had an array type, its element type might be a typedef
1589 // type with an alignment attribute.
1590 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1591 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1592 return Align;
1593
1594 // Otherwise, see if the declaration of the type had an attribute.
1595 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TagType>())
1596 return TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment();
1597
1598 return 0;
1599}
1600
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001601TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001602 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1603 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1604 return I->second;
1605
1606 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1607 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1608 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001609 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001610}
1611
1612/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1613/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001614///
1615/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1616/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1617/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001618TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1619 uint64_t Width = 0;
1620 unsigned Align = 8;
1621 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001622 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001623#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1624#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001625#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001626#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001627#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1628 case Type::Class: \
1629 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1630 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001631#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001632 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001633
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001634 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1635 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001636 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1637 Width = 0;
1638 Align = 32;
1639 break;
1640
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001641 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001642 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001643 Width = 0;
1644 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1645 break;
1646
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001647 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001648 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001649
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001650 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001651 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001652 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001653 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001654 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1655 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001656 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1657 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001658 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001659 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001660 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001661 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001662 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001663 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001664 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1665 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001666 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001667 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1668 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001669 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001670 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001671 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001672 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001673 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1674 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1675 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1676 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001677 break;
1678 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001679
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001680 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001681 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001682 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001683 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001684 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1685 Width = 0;
1686 Align = 8;
1687 break;
1688
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001689 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001690 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1691 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001692 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001693 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1694 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1695 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001696 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001697 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1698 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001699 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001700 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1701 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001702 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1703 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001704 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001705 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001706 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1707 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001708 break;
1709 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001710 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1711 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001712 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001713 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001714 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001715 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1716 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001717 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001718 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001719 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001720 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1721 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001722 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001723 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001724 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001725 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1726 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001727 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001728 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001729 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001730 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1731 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001732 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001733 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1734 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1735 Width = 128;
1736 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1737 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001738 case BuiltinType::Half:
1739 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1740 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1741 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001742 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001743 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1744 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001745 break;
1746 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001747 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1748 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001749 break;
1750 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001751 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1752 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001753 break;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001754 case BuiltinType::Float128:
1755 Width = Target->getFloat128Width();
1756 Align = Target->getFloat128Align();
1757 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001758 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001759 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1760 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001761 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001762 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1763 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1764 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001765 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1766 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001767 break;
Yaxun Liu0bc4b2d2016-07-28 19:26:30 +00001768 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler: {
1769 auto AS = getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_constant);
1770 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1771 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001772 break;
Yaxun Liu0bc4b2d2016-07-28 19:26:30 +00001773 }
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001774 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001775 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
1776 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001777 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001778 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1779 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1780 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1781 break;
Yaxun Liu99444cb2016-08-03 20:38:06 +00001782#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1783 case BuiltinType::Id:
1784#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
1785 {
1786 auto AS = getTargetAddressSpace(Target->getOpenCLImageAddrSpace());
1787 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1788 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1789 }
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001790 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001791 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001792 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001793 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1794 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001795 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001796 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001797 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1798 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001799 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1800 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001801 break;
1802 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001803 case Type::LValueReference:
1804 case Type::RValueReference: {
1805 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1806 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001807 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1808 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001809 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1810 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001811 break;
1812 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001813 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001814 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001815 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1816 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001817 break;
1818 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001819 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001820 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Benjamin Kramer867ea1d2014-03-02 13:01:17 +00001821 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001822 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001823 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001824 case Type::Complex: {
1825 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1826 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001827 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1828 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1829 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001830 break;
1831 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001832 case Type::ObjCObject:
1833 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001834 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001835 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001836 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001837 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001838 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001839 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001840 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001841 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001842 break;
1843 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001844 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001845 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001846 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1847
1848 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001849 Width = 8;
1850 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001851 break;
1852 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001853
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001854 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1855 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1856 TypeInfo Info =
1857 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1858 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1859 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1860 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1861 }
1862 return Info;
1863 }
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001864
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001865 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001866 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1867 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001868 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001869 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001870 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001871 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001872 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001873
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001874 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001875 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1876 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001877
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00001878 case Type::Auto:
1879 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: {
1880 const DeducedType *A = cast<DeducedType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001881 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1882 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001883 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001884 }
1885
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001886 case Type::Paren:
1887 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1888
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00001889 case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
1890 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1891
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001892 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001893 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001894 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001895 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1896 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1897 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001898 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001899 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001900 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001901 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001902 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001903 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1904 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001905 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001906 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001907 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001908
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001909 case Type::Elaborated:
1910 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001911
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001912 case Type::Attributed:
1913 return getTypeInfo(
1914 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1915
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001916 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001917 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001918 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1919 Width = Info.Width;
1920 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001921
1922 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1923 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1924 // favorable to atomic operations:
1925 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1926 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1927 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1928 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1929
1930 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001931 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1932 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001933 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00001934 break;
1935
1936 case Type::Pipe: {
1937 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<PipeType>(T)->getElementType());
1938 Width = Info.Width;
1939 Align = Info.Align;
1940 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001941
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001942 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001943
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001944 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001945 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001946}
1947
Alexey Bataev00396512015-07-02 03:40:19 +00001948unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1949 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1950 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1951 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1952 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1953 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1954 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1955 SimdAlign = 256;
1956 return SimdAlign;
1957}
1958
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001959/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1960CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1961 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1962}
1963
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001964/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1965int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1966 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1967}
1968
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001969/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1970/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001971CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001972 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001973}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001974CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001975 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001976}
1977
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001978/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001979/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001980CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001981 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001982}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001983CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001984 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001985}
1986
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001987/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1988/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1989/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1990/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001991unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001992 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1993 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001994
David Majnemere1544562015-04-24 01:25:05 +00001995 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1996
1997 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
1998 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
1999 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
2000
Andrey Turetskiydb6655f2016-02-10 11:58:46 +00002001 if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment())
2002 return ABIAlign;
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00002003
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002004 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00002005 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002006 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00002007 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
2008 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002009 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00002010 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
2011 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002012 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
2013 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00002014 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002015 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002016
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00002017 return ABIAlign;
2018}
2019
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002020/// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
2021/// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
2022/// value is specified.
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00002023unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002024 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
2025}
2026
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00002027/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
2028/// to a global variable of the specified type.
2029unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
2030 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
2031}
2032
2033/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
2034/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
2035CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
2036 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
2037}
2038
David Majnemer08ef2ba2015-06-23 20:34:18 +00002039CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
2040 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
2041 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2042 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
2043 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
2044 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
2045 }
2046 return Offset;
2047}
2048
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002049/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
2050/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
2051/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
2052/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
2053/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00002054///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002055void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
2056 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002057 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002058 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
2059 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
2060 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00002061 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
2062 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00002063 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002064 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002065 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002066 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
2067 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
2068 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00002069}
2070
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002071/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
2072/// those inherited by it.
2073void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00002074 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002075 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00002076 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
2077 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00002078 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002079 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00002080 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002081
2082 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00002083 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
2084 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002085
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002086 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
2087 while (SD) {
2088 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
2089 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
2090 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002091 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00002092 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002093 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002094 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002095 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002096 // Insert the protocol.
2097 if (!Protocols.insert(
2098 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
2099 return;
2100
2101 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
2102 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002103 }
2104}
2105
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002106unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002107 unsigned count = 0;
2108 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00002109 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002110 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002111
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002112 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
2113 // includes synthesized ivars.
2114 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002115 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2116
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00002117 return count;
2118}
2119
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00002120bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2121 if (!E)
2122 return false;
2123
2124 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2125 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2126
2127 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2128 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2129 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2130 return true;
2131
2132 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2133 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2134
2135 return false;
2136}
2137
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002138/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
2139ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2140 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2141 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2142 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2143 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002144 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002145}
2146/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
2147ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2148 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2149 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2150 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2151 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002152 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002153}
2154
2155/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2156void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2157 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2158 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2159 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2160}
2161/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2162void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2163 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2164 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2165 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2166}
2167
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00002168const ObjCMethodDecl *
2169ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2170 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2171}
2172
2173void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2174 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2175 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2176 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2177}
2178
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002179const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2180 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2181 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2182 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002183 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002184 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2185 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002186 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002187 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2188 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002189 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2190
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002191 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002192}
2193
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002194/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
2195/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002196Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002197 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2198 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2199 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002200 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002201 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002202 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002203}
2204
2205/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2206void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2207 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002208 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2209 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002210 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2211}
2212
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002213TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002214 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002215 if (!DataSize)
2216 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2217 else
2218 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002219 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002220
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002221 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2222 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2223 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2224 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00002225}
2226
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002227TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00002228 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002229 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00002230 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00002231 return DI;
2232}
2233
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002234const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002235ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002236 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002237}
2238
2239const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002240ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2241 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002242 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2243}
2244
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002245//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2246// Type creation/memoization methods
2247//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2248
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002249QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002250ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2251 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2252 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002253
2254 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2255 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002256 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002257 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002258 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2259 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2260 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002261 }
2262
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002263 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2264 QualType canon;
2265 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2266 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002267 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2268 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002269
2270 // Re-find the insert position.
2271 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2272 }
2273
2274 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2275 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2276 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002277}
2278
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002279QualType
2280ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002281 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2282 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002283 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002284
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002285 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2286 // into one ExtQuals node.
2287 QualifierCollector Quals;
2288 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002289
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002290 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2291 // another one.
2292 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2293 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2294 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002295
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002296 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002297}
2298
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002299QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002300 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002301 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002302 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002303 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002304
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002305 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2306 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002307 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002308 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2309 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2310 }
2311 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002312
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002313 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2314 // into one ExtQuals node.
2315 QualifierCollector Quals;
2316 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002317
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002318 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2319 // another one.
2320 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2321 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2322 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002323
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002324 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002325}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002326
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002327const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2328 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2329 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2330 return T;
2331
2332 QualType Result;
2333 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002334 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002335 } else {
2336 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2337 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2338 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002339 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002340 }
2341
2342 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2343}
2344
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002345void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2346 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002347 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2348 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002349 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2350 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002351 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002352 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2353 FD = Next;
2354 else
2355 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002356 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002357 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2358 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002359}
2360
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002361/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2362/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2363/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2364/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2365static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2366 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2367 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2368 // Might have some parens.
2369 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2370 return Context.getParenType(
2371 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2372
2373 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2374 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2375 return Context.getAttributedType(
2376 AT->getAttrKind(),
2377 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2378 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2379 ESI));
2380
2381 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2382 // specification.
2383 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2384 return Context.getFunctionType(
2385 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2386 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2387}
2388
Richard Smithdfe85e22016-12-15 02:35:39 +00002389bool ASTContext::hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(QualType T,
2390 QualType U) {
2391 return hasSameType(T, U) ||
2392 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1z &&
2393 hasSameType(getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, T, EST_None),
2394 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, U, EST_None)));
2395}
2396
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002397void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2398 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2399 bool AsWritten) {
2400 // Update the type.
2401 QualType Updated =
2402 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2403 FD->setType(Updated);
2404
2405 if (!AsWritten)
2406 return;
2407
2408 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2409 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2410 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2411 // the type-as-written too.
2412 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2413 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2414
2415 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2416 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2417 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2418 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2419 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2420 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2421 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2422 }
2423}
2424
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002425/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2426/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002427QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002428 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2429 // structure.
2430 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2431 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002432
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002433 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002434 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2435 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002436
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002437 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2438 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2439 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002440 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002441 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002442
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002443 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2444 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002445 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002446 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002447 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002448 Types.push_back(New);
2449 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2450 return QualType(New, 0);
2451}
2452
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002453/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2454/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002455QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002456 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2457 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002458 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002459 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002460
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002461 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002462 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002463 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002464
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002465 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2466 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002467 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002468 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002469 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002470
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002471 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2472 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002473 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002474 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002475 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002476 Types.push_back(New);
2477 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002478 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002479}
2480
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002481QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2482 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2483 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002484 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002485 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2486 if (AT)
2487 return QualType(AT, 0);
2488
2489 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2490
2491 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2492 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002493 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002494
2495 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2496 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2497 Types.push_back(AT);
2498 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2499 return QualType(AT, 0);
2500}
2501
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002502QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2503 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2504
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002505 QualType Decayed;
2506
2507 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2508 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2509 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2510 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2511 // the array type derivation.
2512 if (T->isArrayType())
2513 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2514
2515 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2516 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2517 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2518 // in 6.3.2.1.
2519 if (T->isFunctionType())
2520 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2521
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002522 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2523 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002524 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002525 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2526 if (AT)
2527 return QualType(AT, 0);
2528
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002529 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2530
2531 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002532 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002533 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002534
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002535 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2536 Types.push_back(AT);
2537 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2538 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002539}
2540
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002541/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002542/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002543QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002544 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2545 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002546 // structure.
2547 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2548 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002549
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002550 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002551 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2552 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2553 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002554
2555 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002556 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2557 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002558 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002559 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002560
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002561 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2562 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2563 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002564 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002565 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002566 BlockPointerType *New
2567 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002568 Types.push_back(New);
2569 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2570 return QualType(New, 0);
2571}
2572
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002573/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2574/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002575QualType
2576ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002577 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2578 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2579
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002580 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2581 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002582 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002583 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002584
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002585 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002586 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2587 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002588 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002589
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002590 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2591
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002592 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2593 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2594 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002595 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2596 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2597 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002598
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002599 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002600 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2601 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002602 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002603 }
2604
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002605 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002606 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2607 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002608 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002609 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002610
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002611 return QualType(New, 0);
2612}
2613
2614/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2615/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002616QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002617 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2618 // structure.
2619 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002620 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002621
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002622 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002623 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2624 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2625 return QualType(RT, 0);
2626
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002627 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2628
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002629 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2630 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2631 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002632 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2633 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2634 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002635
2636 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2637 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2638 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002639 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002640 }
2641
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002642 RValueReferenceType *New
2643 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002644 Types.push_back(New);
2645 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002646 return QualType(New, 0);
2647}
2648
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002649/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2650/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002651QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002652 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2653 // structure.
2654 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2655 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2656
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002657 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002658 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2659 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2660 return QualType(PT, 0);
2661
2662 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2663 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2664 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002665 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002666 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2667
2668 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2669 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2670 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002671 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002672 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002673 MemberPointerType *New
2674 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002675 Types.push_back(New);
2676 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2677 return QualType(New, 0);
2678}
2679
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002680/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002681/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002682QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002683 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002684 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002685 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002686 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2687 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002688 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2689
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002690 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2691 // the target.
2692 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002693 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002694 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002695
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002696 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002697 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002698
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002699 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002700 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002701 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002702 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002703
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002704 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2705 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2706 QualType Canon;
2707 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2708 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002709 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002710 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002711 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002712
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002713 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002714 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002715 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002716 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002717 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002718
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002719 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002720 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002721 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002722 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002723 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002724}
2725
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002726/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2727/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2728/// sizes replaced with [*].
2729QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2730 // Vastly most common case.
2731 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002732
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002733 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002734
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002735 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002736 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002737 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2738#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2739#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2740#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2741#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2742 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2743
2744 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2745 case Type::Builtin:
2746 case Type::Complex:
2747 case Type::Vector:
2748 case Type::ExtVector:
2749 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2750 case Type::ObjCObject:
2751 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2752 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2753 case Type::Record:
2754 case Type::Enum:
2755 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2756 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2757 case Type::TypeOf:
2758 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002759 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002760 case Type::DependentName:
2761 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2762 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2763 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2764 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2765 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002766 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00002767 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002768 case Type::PackExpansion:
2769 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2770
2771 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2772 // further decay.
2773 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2774 case Type::FunctionProto:
2775 case Type::BlockPointer:
2776 case Type::MemberPointer:
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00002777 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002778 return type;
2779
2780 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2781 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2782 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2783 // optimizations available here.
2784 case Type::Pointer:
2785 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2786 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2787 break;
2788
2789 case Type::LValueReference: {
2790 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2791 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2792 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2793 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2794 break;
2795 }
2796
2797 case Type::RValueReference: {
2798 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2799 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2800 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2801 break;
2802 }
2803
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002804 case Type::Atomic: {
2805 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2806 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2807 break;
2808 }
2809
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002810 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2811 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2812 result = getConstantArrayType(
2813 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2814 cat->getSize(),
2815 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2816 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2817 break;
2818 }
2819
2820 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2821 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2822 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2823 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2824 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2825 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2826 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2827 dat->getBracketsRange());
2828 break;
2829 }
2830
2831 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2832 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2833 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2834 result = getVariableArrayType(
2835 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002836 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002837 ArrayType::Normal,
2838 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2839 SourceRange());
2840 break;
2841 }
2842
2843 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2844 case Type::VariableArray: {
2845 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2846 result = getVariableArrayType(
2847 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002848 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002849 ArrayType::Star,
2850 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2851 vat->getBracketsRange());
2852 break;
2853 }
2854 }
2855
2856 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002857 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002858}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002859
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002860/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2861/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002862QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2863 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002864 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002865 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002866 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002867 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2868 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002869 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002870
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002871 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2872 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2873 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002874 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002875 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002876 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002877 }
2878
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002879 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002880 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002881
2882 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2883 Types.push_back(New);
2884 return QualType(New, 0);
2885}
2886
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002887/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2888/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002889/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002890QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2891 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002892 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002893 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2894 SourceRange brackets) const {
2895 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2896 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002897 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2898
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002899 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2900 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2901 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2902 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2903 if (!numElements) {
2904 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2905 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2906 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2907 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2908 brackets);
2909 Types.push_back(newType);
2910 return QualType(newType, 0);
2911 }
2912
2913 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2914 // also build a canonical type.
2915
2916 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2917
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002918 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002919 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002920 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002921 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002922 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002923
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002924 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2925 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2926 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002927
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002928 // If we don't have one, build one.
2929 if (!canonTy) {
2930 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002931 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002932 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2933 brackets);
2934 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2935 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002936 }
2937
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002938 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2939 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002940 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002941
David Majnemer16a74702015-07-24 05:54:19 +00002942 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
2943 // expression, then just use that as our result.
2944 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
2945 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002946 return canon;
2947
2948 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2949 // of the element type.
2950 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2951 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2952 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2953 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2954 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2955 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002956}
2957
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002958QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002959 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002960 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002961 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002962 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002963
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002964 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002965 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2966 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2967 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002968
2969 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002970 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2971 // qualifiers off the element type.
2972 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002973
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002974 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2975 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002976 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002977 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002978 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002979
2980 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002981 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2982 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2983 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002984 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002985
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002986 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2987 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002988
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002989 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2990 Types.push_back(newType);
2991 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002992}
2993
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002994/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2995/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002996QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002997 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002998 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002999
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003000 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3001 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003002 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00003003
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003004 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003005 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3006 return QualType(VTP, 0);
3007
3008 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3009 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3010 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00003011 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00003012 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003013
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003014 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3015 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003016 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003017 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003018 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003019 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003020 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3021 Types.push_back(New);
3022 return QualType(New, 0);
3023}
3024
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003025/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003026/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003027QualType
3028ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00003029 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003030
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003031 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3032 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00003033 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003034 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003035 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003036 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3037 return QualType(VTP, 0);
3038
3039 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3040 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3041 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003042 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003043 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003044
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003045 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3046 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003047 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003048 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003049 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3050 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003051 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3052 Types.push_back(New);
3053 return QualType(New, 0);
3054}
3055
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003056QualType
3057ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
3058 Expr *SizeExpr,
3059 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003060 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003061 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003062 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003063
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003064 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003065 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
3066 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3067 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
3068 if (Canon) {
3069 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
3070 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003071 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3072 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
3073 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003074 } else {
3075 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
3076 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003077 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3078 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
3079 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003080
3081 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
3082 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3083 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
3084 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003085 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3086 } else {
3087 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
3088 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003089 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3090 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003091 }
3092 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003093
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00003094 Types.push_back(New);
3095 return QualType(New, 0);
3096}
3097
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003098/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
3099static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
3100 return T.isCanonical() &&
3101 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
3102 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
3103}
3104
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003105/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003106///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003107QualType
3108ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
3109 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003110 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3111 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003112 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00003113 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003114
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003115 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003116 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003117 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003118 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003119
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003120 QualType Canonical;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003121 if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) {
3122 Canonical =
3123 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003124
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003125 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003126 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
3127 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003128 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003129 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003130
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003131 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003132 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003133 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003134 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003135 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003136}
3137
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003138CanQualType
3139ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
3140 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
3141
3142 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3143 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3144 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
3145 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3146 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
3147 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
3148 }
3149
3150 return CanResultType;
3151}
3152
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003153static bool isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(
3154 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, bool NoexceptInType) {
3155 if (ESI.Type == EST_None)
3156 return true;
3157 if (!NoexceptInType)
3158 return false;
3159
3160 // C++17 onwards: exception specification is part of the type, as a simple
3161 // boolean "can this function type throw".
3162 if (ESI.Type == EST_BasicNoexcept)
3163 return true;
3164
3165 // A dynamic exception specification is canonical if it only contains pack
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003166 // expansions (so we can't tell whether it's non-throwing) and all its
3167 // contained types are canonical.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003168 if (ESI.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
Richard Smithfda59e52016-10-26 01:05:54 +00003169 bool AnyPackExpansions = false;
3170 for (QualType ET : ESI.Exceptions) {
3171 if (!ET.isCanonical())
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003172 return false;
Richard Smithfda59e52016-10-26 01:05:54 +00003173 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
3174 AnyPackExpansions = true;
3175 }
3176 return AnyPackExpansions;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003177 }
3178
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003179 // A noexcept(expr) specification is (possibly) canonical if expr is
3180 // value-dependent.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003181 if (ESI.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept)
3182 return ESI.NoexceptExpr && ESI.NoexceptExpr->isValueDependent();
3183
3184 return false;
3185}
3186
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003187QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeInternal(
3188 QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
3189 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI, bool OnlyWantCanonical) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003190 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
3191
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003192 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3193 // structure.
3194 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3195 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
3196 *this, true);
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003197
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003198 QualType Canonical;
3199 bool Unique = false;
3200
3201 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3202 if (FunctionProtoType *FPT =
3203 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) {
3204 QualType Existing = QualType(FPT, 0);
3205
3206 // If we find a pre-existing equivalent FunctionProtoType, we can just reuse
3207 // it so long as our exception specification doesn't contain a dependent
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003208 // noexcept expression, or we're just looking for a canonical type.
3209 // Otherwise, we're going to need to create a type
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003210 // sugar node to hold the concrete expression.
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003211 if (OnlyWantCanonical || EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type != EST_ComputedNoexcept ||
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003212 EPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr == FPT->getNoexceptExpr())
3213 return Existing;
3214
3215 // We need a new type sugar node for this one, to hold the new noexcept
3216 // expression. We do no canonicalization here, but that's OK since we don't
3217 // expect to see the same noexcept expression much more than once.
3218 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Existing);
3219 Unique = true;
3220 }
3221
3222 bool NoexceptInType = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1z;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003223 bool IsCanonicalExceptionSpec =
3224 isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(EPI.ExceptionSpec, NoexceptInType);
3225
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003226 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003227 bool isCanonical = !Unique && IsCanonicalExceptionSpec &&
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003228 isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) && !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003229 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003230 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003231 isCanonical = false;
3232
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003233 if (OnlyWantCanonical)
3234 assert(isCanonical &&
3235 "given non-canonical parameters constructing canonical type");
3236
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003237 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it if we don't
3238 // already have it. The exception spec is only partially part of the
3239 // canonical type, and only in C++17 onwards.
3240 if (!isCanonical && Canonical.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003241 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003242 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3243 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003244 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003245
Benjamin Kramer3f515cd2016-10-26 12:51:45 +00003246 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ExceptionTypeStorage;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003247 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003248 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003249
3250 if (IsCanonicalExceptionSpec) {
3251 // Exception spec is already OK.
3252 } else if (NoexceptInType) {
3253 switch (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) {
3254 case EST_Unparsed: case EST_Unevaluated: case EST_Uninstantiated:
3255 // We don't know yet. It shouldn't matter what we pick here; no-one
3256 // should ever look at this.
3257 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003258 case EST_None: case EST_MSAny:
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003259 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3260 break;
3261
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003262 // A dynamic exception specification is almost always "not noexcept",
3263 // with the exception that a pack expansion might expand to no types.
3264 case EST_Dynamic: {
3265 bool AnyPacks = false;
3266 for (QualType ET : EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions) {
3267 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
3268 AnyPacks = true;
3269 ExceptionTypeStorage.push_back(getCanonicalType(ET));
3270 }
3271 if (!AnyPacks)
3272 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3273 else {
3274 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_Dynamic;
3275 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions = ExceptionTypeStorage;
3276 }
3277 break;
3278 }
3279
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003280 case EST_DynamicNone: case EST_BasicNoexcept:
3281 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_BasicNoexcept;
3282 break;
3283
3284 case EST_ComputedNoexcept:
3285 llvm::APSInt Value(1);
3286 auto *E = CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr;
3287 if (!E || !E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Value, *this, nullptr,
3288 /*IsEvaluated*/false)) {
3289 // This noexcept specification is invalid.
3290 // FIXME: Should this be able to happen?
3291 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3292 break;
3293 }
3294
3295 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
3296 Value.getBoolValue() ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_None;
3297 break;
3298 }
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003299 } else {
3300 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
3301 }
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003302
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003303 // Adjust the canonical function result type.
3304 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003305 Canonical =
3306 getFunctionTypeInternal(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI, true);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003307
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003308 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003309 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3310 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003311 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003312 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003313
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003314 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3315 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3316 // - parameter types
3317 // - exception types
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003318 // - extended parameter information
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003319 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003320 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3321 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003322 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003323 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003324
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003325 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3326 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3327 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00003328 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003329 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00003330 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003331 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003332 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003333 }
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003334
3335 // Put the ExtParameterInfos last. If all were equal, it would make
3336 // more sense to put these before the exception specification, because
3337 // it's much easier to skip past them compared to the elaborate switch
3338 // required to skip the exception specification. However, all is not
3339 // equal; ExtParameterInfos are used to model very uncommon features,
3340 // and it's better not to burden the more common paths.
3341 if (EPI.ExtParameterInfos) {
3342 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo);
3343 }
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003344
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003345 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003346 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003347 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003348 Types.push_back(FTP);
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003349 if (!Unique)
3350 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003351 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003352}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00003353
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003354QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T, bool ReadOnly) const {
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003355 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003356 PipeType::Profile(ID, T, ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003357
3358 void *InsertPos = 0;
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003359 if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003360 return QualType(PT, 0);
3361
3362 // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3363 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3364 QualType Canonical;
3365 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003366 Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T), ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003367
3368 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003369 PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003370 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3371 (void)NewIP;
3372 }
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003373 PipeType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PipeType(T, Canonical, ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003374 Types.push_back(New);
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003375 PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00003376 return QualType(New, 0);
3377}
3378
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003379QualType ASTContext::getReadPipeType(QualType T) const {
3380 return getPipeType(T, true);
3381}
3382
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00003383QualType ASTContext::getWritePipeType(QualType T) const {
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003384 return getPipeType(T, false);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003385}
3386
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003387#ifndef NDEBUG
3388static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3389 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3390 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3391 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3392 return true;
3393 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3394 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3395 return true;
3396 return false;
3397}
3398#endif
3399
3400/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3401/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3402QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003403 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003404 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3405 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3406 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003407 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003408 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3409 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3410 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3411 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003412 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003413 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003414 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3415 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003416 }
3417 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3418}
3419
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003420/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3421/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003422QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003423 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003424 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003425
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003426 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003427 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003428
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003429 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3430 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3431
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003432 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003433 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003434 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003435 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003436 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003437 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003438 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003439 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003440 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003441 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3442 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3443 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003444 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003445 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003446
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003447 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003448}
3449
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003450/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003451/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003452QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003453ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3454 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003455 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003456
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003457 if (Canonical.isNull())
3458 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003459 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003460 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003461 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3462 Types.push_back(newType);
3463 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003464}
3465
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003466QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003467 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3468
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003469 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003470 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3471 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3472
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003473 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3474 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3475 Types.push_back(newType);
3476 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003477}
3478
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003479QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003480 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3481
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003482 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003483 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3484 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3485
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003486 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3487 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3488 Types.push_back(newType);
3489 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003490}
3491
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003492QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3493 QualType modifiedType,
3494 QualType equivalentType) {
3495 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3496 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3497
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003498 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003499 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3500 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3501
3502 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3503 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3504 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3505
3506 Types.push_back(type);
3507 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3508
3509 return QualType(type, 0);
3510}
3511
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003512/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3513QualType
3514ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003515 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003516 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003517 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3518
3519 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3520 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003521 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003522 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3523 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3524
3525 if (!SubstParm) {
3526 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3527 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3528 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3529 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3530 }
3531
3532 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3533}
3534
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003535/// \brief Retrieve a
3536QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3537 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3538 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3539#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003540 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3541 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3542 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003543 }
3544#endif
3545
3546 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3547 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003548 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003549 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3550 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3551 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3552
3553 QualType Canon;
3554 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3555 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3556 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3557 ArgPack);
3558 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3559 }
3560
3561 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3562 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3563 ArgPack);
3564 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3565 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3566 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3567}
3568
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003569/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003570/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003571/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003572QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003573 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003574 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003575 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003576 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003577 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003578 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003579 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3580
3581 if (TypeParm)
3582 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003583
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003584 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003585 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003586 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003587
3588 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3589 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3590 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3591 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003592 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003593 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3594 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003595
3596 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3597 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3598
3599 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3600}
3601
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003602TypeSourceInfo *
3603ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3604 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3605 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003606 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003607 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3608 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003609 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003610
3611 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003612 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3613 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003614 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003615 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3616 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3617 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3618 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3619 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3620 return DI;
3621}
3622
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003623QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003624ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003625 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003626 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003627 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3628 "No dependent template names here!");
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003629
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003630 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003631 ArgVec.reserve(Args.size());
3632 for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : Args.arguments())
3633 ArgVec.push_back(Arg.getArgument());
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003634
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003635 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec, Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003636}
3637
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003638#ifndef NDEBUG
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003639static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) {
3640 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3641 if (Arg.isPackExpansion())
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003642 return true;
3643
3644 return true;
3645}
3646#endif
3647
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003648QualType
3649ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003650 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003651 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003652 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3653 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003654 // Look through qualified template names.
3655 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3656 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003657
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003658 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003659 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3660 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003661 QualType CanonType;
3662 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3663 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3664 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003665 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3666 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003667 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args)) &&
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003668 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3669 IsTypeAlias = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003670 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args);
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003671 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003672
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003673 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3674 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3675 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003676 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003677 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size() +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003678 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003679 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003680 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003681 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, CanonType,
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003682 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003683
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003684 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003685 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003686}
3687
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003688QualType ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(
3689 TemplateName Template, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003690 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3691 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003692
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003693 // Look through qualified template names.
3694 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3695 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003696
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003697 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3698 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003699 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003700 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003701 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003702 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3703 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Arg));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003704
3705 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3706 // exists.
3707 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3708 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003709 CanonArgs, *this);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003710
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003711 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003712 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3713 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3714
3715 if (!Spec) {
3716 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3717 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3718 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3719 TypeAlignment);
3720 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003721 CanonArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003722 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003723 Types.push_back(Spec);
3724 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3725 }
3726
3727 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3728 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3729 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3730}
3731
3732QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003733ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3734 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003735 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003736 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003737 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003738
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003739 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003740 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003741 if (T)
3742 return QualType(T, 0);
3743
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003744 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3745 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3746 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003747 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3748 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003749 (void)CheckT;
3750 }
3751
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003752 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003753 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003754 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003755 return QualType(T, 0);
3756}
3757
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003758QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003759ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003760 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3761 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3762
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003763 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003764 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3765 if (T)
3766 return QualType(T, 0);
3767
3768 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3769 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3770 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3771 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3772 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3773 (void)CheckT;
3774 }
3775
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003776 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003777 Types.push_back(T);
3778 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3779 return QualType(T, 0);
3780}
3781
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003782QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3783 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3784 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003785 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003786 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3787 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Richard Smith74f02342017-01-19 21:00:13 +00003788 if (CanonNNS != NNS)
3789 Canon = getDependentNameType(Keyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003790 }
3791
3792 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003793 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003794
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003795 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003796 DependentNameType *T
3797 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003798 if (T)
3799 return QualType(T, 0);
3800
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003801 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003802 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003803 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003804 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003805}
3806
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003807QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003808ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3809 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003810 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003811 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003812 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003813 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003814 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003815 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3816 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003817 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, ArgCopy);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003818}
3819
3820QualType
3821ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3822 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3823 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3824 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003825 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003826 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3827 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003828
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003829 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003830 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003831 Name, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003832
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003833 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003834 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3835 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003836 if (T)
3837 return QualType(T, 0);
3838
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003839 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003840
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003841 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3842 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3843
3844 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003845 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003846 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003847 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3848 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3849 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3850 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003851 }
3852
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003853 QualType Canon;
3854 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3855 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003856 Name,
3857 CanonArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003858
3859 // Find the insert position again.
3860 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3861 }
3862
3863 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3864 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3865 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003866 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003867 Name, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003868 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003869 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003870 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003871}
3872
Richard Smith32918772017-02-14 00:25:28 +00003873TemplateArgument ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArg(NamedDecl *Param) {
3874 TemplateArgument Arg;
3875 if (auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Param)) {
3876 QualType ArgType = getTypeDeclType(TTP);
3877 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
3878 ArgType = getPackExpansionType(ArgType, None);
3879
3880 Arg = TemplateArgument(ArgType);
3881 } else if (auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Param)) {
3882 Expr *E = new (*this) DeclRefExpr(
3883 NTTP, /*enclosing*/false,
3884 NTTP->getType().getNonLValueExprType(*this),
3885 Expr::getValueKindForType(NTTP->getType()), NTTP->getLocation());
3886
3887 if (NTTP->isParameterPack())
3888 E = new (*this) PackExpansionExpr(DependentTy, E, NTTP->getLocation(),
3889 None);
3890 Arg = TemplateArgument(E);
3891 } else {
3892 auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Param);
3893 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
3894 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP), Optional<unsigned>());
3895 else
3896 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP));
3897 }
3898
3899 if (Param->isTemplateParameterPack())
3900 Arg = TemplateArgument::CreatePackCopy(*this, Arg);
3901
3902 return Arg;
3903}
3904
Richard Smith43e14d22016-12-23 02:10:11 +00003905void
3906ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArgs(const TemplateParameterList *Params,
3907 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &Args) {
3908 Args.reserve(Args.size() + Params->size());
3909
Richard Smith32918772017-02-14 00:25:28 +00003910 for (NamedDecl *Param : *Params)
3911 Args.push_back(getInjectedTemplateArg(Param));
Richard Smith43e14d22016-12-23 02:10:11 +00003912}
3913
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003914QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003915 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003916 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003917 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003918
3919 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3920 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003921 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003922 PackExpansionType *T
3923 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3924 if (T)
3925 return QualType(T, 0);
3926
3927 QualType Canon;
3928 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003929 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3930 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3931 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3932 // parameters.
3933 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003934 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003935
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003936 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3937 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3938 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3939 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003940 }
3941
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00003942 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3943 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003944 Types.push_back(T);
3945 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00003946 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003947}
3948
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003949/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3950/// alphabetically.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003951static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
3952 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
3953 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003954}
3955
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003956static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) {
3957 if (Protocols.empty()) return true;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003958
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003959 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3960 return false;
3961
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00003962 for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i)
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00003963 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003964 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003965 return false;
3966 return true;
3967}
3968
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003969static void
3970SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003971 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003972 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003973
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003974 // Canonicalize.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003975 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
3976 P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
3977
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003978 // Remove duplicates.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00003979 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
3980 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003981}
3982
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003983QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3984 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003985 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003986 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, { },
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003987 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
3988 /*isKindOf=*/false);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003989}
3990
3991QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
3992 QualType baseType,
3993 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003994 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
3995 bool isKindOf) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00003996 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
3997 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00003998 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
3999 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004000 return baseType;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004001
4002 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004003 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004004 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004005 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004006 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4007 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004008
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004009 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
4010 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
4011 // type.
4012 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
4013 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
4014 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
4015 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
4016 }
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004017
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004018 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
4019 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
4020 // canonicalized.
4021 QualType canonical;
4022 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
4023 effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
4024 [&](QualType type) {
4025 return type.isCanonical();
4026 });
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004027 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004028 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
4029 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
4030 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
4031 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
4032 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
4033 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
4034 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
4035 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
4036 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004037 } else {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004038 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004039 }
4040
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004041 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
4042 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
4043 if (!protocolsSorted) {
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004044 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
4045 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
4046 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004047 } else {
4048 canonProtocols = protocols;
4049 }
4050
4051 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004052 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004053
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004054 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004055 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4056 }
4057
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004058 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
4059 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
4060 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4061 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004062 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004063 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
4064 isKindOf);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004065
4066 Types.push_back(T);
4067 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4068 return QualType(T, 0);
4069}
4070
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004071/// Apply Objective-C protocol qualifiers to the given type.
4072/// If this is for the canonical type of a type parameter, we can apply
4073/// protocol qualifiers on the ObjCObjectPointerType.
4074QualType
4075ASTContext::applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(QualType type,
4076 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, bool &hasError,
4077 bool allowOnPointerType) const {
4078 hasError = false;
4079
Manman Renc5705ba2016-09-13 17:41:05 +00004080 if (const ObjCTypeParamType *objT =
4081 dyn_cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4082 return getObjCTypeParamType(objT->getDecl(), protocols);
4083 }
4084
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004085 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectPointerType.
4086 if (allowOnPointerType) {
4087 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr =
4088 dyn_cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4089 const ObjCObjectType *objT = objPtr->getObjectType();
4090 // Merge protocol lists and construct ObjCObjectType.
4091 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> protocolsVec;
4092 protocolsVec.append(objT->qual_begin(),
4093 objT->qual_end());
4094 protocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
4095 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols = protocolsVec;
4096 type = getObjCObjectType(
4097 objT->getBaseType(),
4098 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4099 protocols,
4100 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4101 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4102 }
4103 }
4104
4105 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectType.
4106 if (const ObjCObjectType *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCObjectType>(type.getTypePtr())){
4107 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4108 // known to conform.
4109
4110 return getObjCObjectType(objT->getBaseType(),
4111 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4112 protocols,
4113 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4114 }
4115
4116 // If the canonical type is ObjCObjectType, ...
4117 if (type->isObjCObjectType()) {
4118 // Silently overwrite any existing protocol qualifiers.
4119 // TODO: determine whether that's the right thing to do.
4120
4121 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4122 // known to conform.
4123 return getObjCObjectType(type, { }, protocols, false);
4124 }
4125
4126 // id<protocol-list>
4127 if (type->isObjCIdType()) {
4128 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4129 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, protocols,
4130 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4131 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4132 }
4133
4134 // Class<protocol-list>
4135 if (type->isObjCClassType()) {
4136 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4137 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, protocols,
4138 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4139 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4140 }
4141
4142 hasError = true;
4143 return type;
4144}
4145
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00004146QualType
4147ASTContext::getObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Decl,
4148 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
4149 QualType Canonical) const {
4150 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4151 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4152 ObjCTypeParamType::Profile(ID, Decl, protocols);
4153 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4154 if (ObjCTypeParamType *TypeParam =
4155 ObjCTypeParamTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4156 return QualType(TypeParam, 0);
4157
4158 if (Canonical.isNull()) {
4159 // We canonicalize to the underlying type.
4160 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
4161 if (!protocols.empty()) {
4162 // Apply the protocol qualifers.
4163 bool hasError;
4164 Canonical = applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(Canonical, protocols, hasError,
4165 true/*allowOnPointerType*/);
4166 assert(!hasError && "Error when apply protocol qualifier to bound type");
4167 }
4168 }
4169
4170 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCTypeParamType);
4171 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4172 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
4173 ObjCTypeParamType *newType = new (mem)
4174 ObjCTypeParamType(Decl, Canonical, protocols);
4175
4176 Types.push_back(newType);
4177 ObjCTypeParamTypes.InsertNode(newType, InsertPos);
4178 return QualType(newType, 0);
4179}
4180
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004181/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
4182/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
4183/// list.
4184bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
4185 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
4186 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4187 return false;
4188
4189 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
4190 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004191 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004192 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
4193 return false;
4194 }
4195 return true;
4196 }
4197 return false;
4198}
4199
4200/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
4201/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
4202/// of protocols.
4203bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
4204 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
4205 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4206 return false;
4207 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4208 if (!OPT)
4209 return false;
4210 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
4211 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004212 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
4213 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
4214 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
4215 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004216 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
4217 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
4218 bool Conforms = false;
4219 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
4220 Conforms = false;
4221 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
4222 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
4223 Conforms = true;
4224 break;
4225 }
4226 }
4227 if (!Conforms)
4228 break;
4229 }
4230 if (Conforms)
4231 return true;
4232
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004233 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004234 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
4235 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004236 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004237 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004238 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004239 break;
4240 }
4241 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004242 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004243 }
4244 return true;
4245}
4246
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004247/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
4248/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004249QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004250 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4251 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
4252
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004253 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004254 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
4255 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4256 return QualType(QT, 0);
4257
4258 // Find the canonical object type.
4259 QualType Canonical;
4260 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
4261 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
4262
4263 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004264 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4265 }
4266
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00004267 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004268 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
4269 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
4270 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004271
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004272 Types.push_back(QType);
4273 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004274 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004275}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004276
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004277/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4278/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004279QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
4280 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004281 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
4282 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004283
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004284 if (PrevDecl) {
4285 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
4286 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
4287 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4288 }
4289
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00004290 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
4291 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
4292 Decl = Def;
4293
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004294 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
4295 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
4296 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
4297 Types.push_back(T);
4298 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00004299}
4300
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004301/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
4302/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004303/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004304/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004305/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004306QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004307 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004308 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
4309 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4310 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004311
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004312 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004313 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
4314 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4315 if (Canon) {
4316 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
4317 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004318 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004319 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00004320 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004321 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004322 Canon
4323 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004324 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4325 toe = Canon;
4326 }
4327 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004328 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004329 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004330 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004331 Types.push_back(toe);
4332 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004333}
4334
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004335/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004336/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004337/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004338/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
4339/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004340QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004341 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004342 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004343 Types.push_back(tot);
4344 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004345}
4346
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004347/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
4348/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
4349/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
4350/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00004351QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004352 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004353
4354 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004355 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004356 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
4357 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004358 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004359 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4360 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004361
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004362 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004363 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
4364 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004365 if (!Canon) {
Yaron Keren633e14a2016-11-29 10:08:20 +00004366 // Build a new, canonical decltype(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004367 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004368 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004369 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004370 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4371 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004372 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004373 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4374 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004375 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00004376 Types.push_back(dt);
4377 return QualType(dt, 0);
4378}
4379
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004380/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
4381/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
4382QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
4383 QualType UnderlyingType,
4384 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
4385 const {
Vassil Vassilevbab6f962016-03-30 22:18:29 +00004386 UnaryTransformType *ut = nullptr;
4387
4388 if (BaseType->isDependentType()) {
4389 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4390 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4391 DependentUnaryTransformType::Profile(ID, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind);
4392
4393 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4394 DependentUnaryTransformType *Canon
4395 = DependentUnaryTransformTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4396
4397 if (!Canon) {
4398 // Build a new, canonical __underlying_type(type) type.
4399 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4400 DependentUnaryTransformType(*this, getCanonicalType(BaseType),
4401 Kind);
4402 DependentUnaryTransformTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4403 }
4404 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4405 QualType(), Kind,
4406 QualType(Canon, 0));
4407 } else {
4408 QualType CanonType = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType);
4409 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4410 UnderlyingType, Kind,
4411 CanonType);
4412 }
4413 Types.push_back(ut);
4414 return QualType(ut, 0);
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004415}
4416
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004417/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
4418/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
4419/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004420QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004421 bool IsDependent) const {
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004422 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004423 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004424
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004425 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004426 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004427 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004428 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004429 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4430 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004431
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00004432 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004433 Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004434 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004435 Types.push_back(AT);
4436 if (InsertPos)
4437 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
4438 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00004439}
4440
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00004441/// Return the uniqued reference to the deduced template specialization type
4442/// which has been deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced
4443/// such type, or the canonical deduced-but-dependent such type.
4444QualType ASTContext::getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(
4445 TemplateName Template, QualType DeducedType, bool IsDependent) const {
4446 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4447 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4448 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4449 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, Template, DeducedType,
4450 IsDependent);
4451 if (DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST =
4452 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4453 return QualType(DTST, 0);
4454
4455 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4456 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, DeducedType, IsDependent);
4457 Types.push_back(DTST);
4458 if (InsertPos)
4459 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(DTST, InsertPos);
4460 return QualType(DTST, 0);
4461}
4462
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004463/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
4464/// the given value type.
4465QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
4466 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
4467 // structure.
4468 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4469 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
4470
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004471 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004472 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4473 return QualType(AT, 0);
4474
4475 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4476 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4477 QualType Canonical;
4478 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4479 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
4480
4481 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4482 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004483 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004484 }
4485 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
4486 Types.push_back(New);
4487 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4488 return QualType(New, 0);
4489}
4490
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004491/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
4492QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
4493 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004494 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004495 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004496 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004497 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004498 return AutoDeductTy;
4499}
4500
4501/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
4502QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
4503 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
4504 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
4505 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
4506 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
4507}
4508
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004509/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4510/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004511QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00004512 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00004513 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
4514 // away const? mutable?
4515 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004516}
4517
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004518/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4519/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4520/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00004521CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004522 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00004523}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004524
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004525/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4526CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4527 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4528}
4529
4530/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4531CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4532 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4533}
4534
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00004535/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4536/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4537QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4538 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4539 return WCharTy;
4540}
4541
4542/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4543/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4544QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4545 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4546 return UnsignedIntTy;
4547}
4548
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00004549QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4550 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4551}
4552
4553QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4554 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4555}
4556
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004557/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004558/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4559QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004560 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004561}
4562
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00004563/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4564/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4565QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4566 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4567}
4568
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004569//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4570// Type Operators
4571//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4572
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004573CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004574 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4575 // qualifiers.
4576 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004577 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004578 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004579 QualType Result;
4580 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4581 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4582 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4583 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4584 } else {
4585 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4586 }
4587
4588 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4589}
4590
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004591QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4592 Qualifiers &quals) {
4593 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4594
4595 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4596 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4597 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4598 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4599 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004600 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004601
4602 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004603 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004604 quals = splitType.Quals;
4605 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004606 }
4607
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004608 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4609 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4610 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4611
4612 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4613 // can just use the results in splitType.
4614 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4615 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004616 quals = splitType.Quals;
4617 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004618 }
4619
4620 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4621 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004622 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004623
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004624 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004625 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004626 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4627 }
4628
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004629 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004630 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004631 }
4632
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004633 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004634 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004635 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004636 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4637 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4638 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4639 }
4640
4641 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004642 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004643 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4644 SourceRange());
4645}
4646
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004647/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4648/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4649/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4650/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4651/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4652/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4653/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4654/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4655bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4656 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4657 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4658 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4659 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4660 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4661 return true;
4662 }
4663
4664 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4665 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4666 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4667 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4668 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4669 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4670 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4671 return true;
4672 }
4673
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004674 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004675 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4676 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4677 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4678 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4679 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4680 return true;
4681 }
4682 }
4683
4684 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4685
4686 return false;
4687}
4688
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004689DeclarationNameInfo
4690ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4691 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004692 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4693 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4694 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004695 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004696 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4697 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004698
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004699 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4700 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4701 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4702 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4703 }
4704
4705 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4706 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004707 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004708 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004709 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4710 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004711 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004712 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4713 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4714 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4715 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4716 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4717 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004718 }
4719 }
4720
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004721 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4722 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4723 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4724 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4725 NameLoc);
4726 }
4727
4728 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4729 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4730 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4731 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4732 NameLoc);
4733 }
4734 }
4735
4736 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004737}
4738
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004739TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004740 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4741 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4742 case TemplateName::Template: {
4743 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004744 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004745 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004746 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4747
4748 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00004749 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00004750 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004751
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004752 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4753 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004754
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004755 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4756 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4757 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4758 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4759 }
4760
4761 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4762 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4763 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4764 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4765 }
4766
4767 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4768 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4769 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4770 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4771 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4772 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4773 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4774 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4775 }
4776 }
4777
4778 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00004779}
4780
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00004781bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4782 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4783 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4784 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4785}
4786
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004787TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004788ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004789 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4790 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4791 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004792
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004793 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004794 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004795
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004796 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004797 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00004798 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00004799 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004800
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00004801 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4802 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4803 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4804
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00004805 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4806 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004807
4808 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4809 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4810 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00004811 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00004812
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004813 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00004814 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004815
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004816 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00004817 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004818
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004819 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00004820 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4821 return Arg;
4822
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00004823 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4824 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004825 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004826 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004827 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4828 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4829 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004830
Benjamin Kramercce63472015-08-05 09:40:22 +00004831 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004832 }
4833 }
4834
4835 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004836 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004837}
4838
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004839NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004840ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004841 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004842 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004843
4844 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4845 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4846 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004847 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004848 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4849 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4850
4851 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4852 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4853 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004854 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004855 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4856
4857 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4858 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4859 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004860 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004861 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4862 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004863
4864 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4865 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4866 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004867
4868 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4869 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4870 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4871 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4872 // types, e.g.,
4873 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4874 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004875 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4876 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004877 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004878
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004879 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4880 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4881 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004882 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4883 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004884 }
4885
4886 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00004887 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4888 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004889 return NNS;
4890 }
4891
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004892 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004893}
4894
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004895const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004896 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004897 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004898 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4899 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4900 return AT;
4901 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004902
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004903 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004904 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004905 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004906
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004907 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004908 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4909 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004910
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004911 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4912 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004913 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004914
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004915 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004916 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004917
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004918 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004919 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004920 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004921 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004922
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004923 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4924 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004925 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004926
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004927 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4928 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4929 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004930 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004931 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4932 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4933 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004934 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004935
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004936 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004937 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4938 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004939 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004940 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004941 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004942 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004943 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004944
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004945 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004946 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004947 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004948 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004949 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004950 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004951}
4952
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004953QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00004954 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4955 return getDecayedType(T);
4956 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004957}
4958
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004959QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004960 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4961 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4962 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4963}
4964
David Majnemerd09a51c2015-03-03 01:50:05 +00004965QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
4966 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
4967 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
4968 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
4969 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
4970 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
4971 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
4972 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4973 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4974 T = getDecayedType(T);
4975 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4976}
4977
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004978/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4979/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4980/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4981/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4982///
4983/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004984QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004985 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4986 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4987 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4988 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4989 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4990 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004991
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004992 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004993
4994 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
Jordan Rose303e2f12016-11-10 23:28:17 +00004995 QualType Result = getQualifiedType(PtrTy,
4996 PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
4997
4998 // int x[_Nullable] -> int * _Nullable
4999 if (auto Nullability = Ty->getNullability(*this)) {
5000 Result = const_cast<ASTContext *>(this)->getAttributedType(
5001 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Nullability), Result, Result);
5002 }
5003 return Result;
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005004}
5005
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005006QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
5007 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00005008}
5009
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005010QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
5011 Qualifiers qs;
5012 while (true) {
5013 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005014 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005015 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005016
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005017 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005018 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005019 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005020
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005021 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00005022}
5023
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005024/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005025uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005026ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
5027 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
5028 do {
5029 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00005030 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
5031 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005032 } while (CA);
5033 return ElementCount;
5034}
5035
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00005036/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
5037/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005038static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005039 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00005040 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005041
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005042 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
5043 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005044 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00005045 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00005046 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
5047 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
5048 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005049 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Float128Rank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005050 }
5051}
5052
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005053/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
5054/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00005055/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
5056/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005057QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
5058 QualType Domain) const {
5059 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
5060 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
5061 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00005062 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005063 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
5064 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
5065 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005066 case Float128Rank: return Float128ComplexTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005067 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00005068 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005069
5070 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
5071 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00005072 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005073 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
5074 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
5075 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005076 case Float128Rank: return Float128Ty;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005077 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00005078 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005079}
5080
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005081/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
5082/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
5083/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005084/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005085int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005086 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
5087 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005088
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005089 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00005090 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005091 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00005092 return 1;
5093 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005094}
5095
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005096/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
5097/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
5098/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005099unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00005100 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00005101
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005102 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005103 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005104 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005105 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005106 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5107 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5108 case BuiltinType::SChar:
5109 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005110 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005111 case BuiltinType::Short:
5112 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005113 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005114 case BuiltinType::Int:
5115 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005116 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005117 case BuiltinType::Long:
5118 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005119 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005120 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
5121 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005122 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00005123 case BuiltinType::Int128:
5124 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
5125 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005126 }
5127}
5128
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005129/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
5130/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
5131///
5132/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
5133/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005134QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00005135 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
5136 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005137
5138 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
5139 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
5140 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
5141
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00005142 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005143 if (!Field)
5144 return QualType();
5145
5146 QualType FT = Field->getType();
5147
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005148 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005149 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005150 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
5151 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
5152 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
5153 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
5154 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
5155 // promotion applies to it.
5156 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
5157 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
5158 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
5159 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
5160 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
5161 //
5162 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
5163 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005164 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
5165 return IntTy;
5166
5167 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
5168 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5169
5170 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005171 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
5172 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
5173 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
5174 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005175 return QualType();
5176}
5177
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005178/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
5179/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
5180/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005181QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005182 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
5183 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00005184 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
5185 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00005186
5187 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5188 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
5189 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
5190 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
5191 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
5192 // unsigned long long int [...]
5193 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
5194 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
5195 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
5196 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
5197 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
5198 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
5199 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
5200 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
5201 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
5202 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
5203 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
5204 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
5205 (FromSize == ToSize &&
5206 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
5207 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
5208 }
5209 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
5210 }
5211 }
5212
5213 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005214 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
5215 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00005216 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
5217 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005218 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
5219 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5220}
5221
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005222/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
5223/// type and returns its ownership.
5224Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
5225 while (!T.isNull()) {
5226 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
5227 return T.getObjCLifetime();
5228 if (T->isArrayType())
5229 T = getBaseElementType(T);
5230 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
5231 T = PT->getPointeeType();
5232 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00005233 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005234 else
5235 break;
5236 }
5237
5238 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
5239}
5240
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005241static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
5242 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
5243 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
5244 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
5245 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005246 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005247}
5248
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005249/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005250/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005251/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005252int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005253 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
5254 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005255
5256 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
5257 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
5258 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5259 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
5260 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5261
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005262 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005263
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005264 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
5265 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005266
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005267 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
5268 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005269
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005270 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
5271 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
5272 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
5273 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005274
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005275 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
5276 if (LHSUnsigned) {
5277 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
5278 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
5279 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005280
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005281 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5282 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005283 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005284 return -1;
5285 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005286
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005287 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
5288 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
5289 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005290
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005291 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5292 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005293 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005294 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005295}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005296
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005297TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005298 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005299 assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl &&
5300 "tag and typedef should be initialized together");
5301 CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag");
5302 CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00005303
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005304 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005305 const char *FieldNames[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005306
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005307 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005308 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005309 FieldNames[0] = "isa";
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005310 // int flags;
5311 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005312 FieldNames[1] = "flags";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005313 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005314 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005315 FieldNames[2] = "str";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005316 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005317 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005318 FieldNames[3] = "length";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005319
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005320 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005321 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005322 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00005323 SourceLocation(),
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005324 SourceLocation(),
5325 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005326 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5327 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00005328 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00005329 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005330 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005331 CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005332 }
5333
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005334 CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5335 // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot
5336 // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface.
5337 auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl);
5338 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
5339 buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString");
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005340 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005341
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005342 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
5343}
5344
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005345RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const {
5346 if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl)
5347 getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef.
5348 return CFConstantStringTagDecl;
5349}
5350
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005351// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
5352QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005353 return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl());
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00005354}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00005355
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005356QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
5357 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005358 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005359 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5360 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5361 }
5362 return ObjCSuperType;
5363}
5364
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005365void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005366 const TypedefType *TD = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
5367 assert(TD && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5368 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl());
5369 auto TagType =
5370 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<RecordType>();
5371 assert(TagType && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5372 CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005373}
5374
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005375QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005376 if (BlockDescriptorType)
5377 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5378
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005379 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005380 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005381 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
5382 RD->startDefinition();
5383
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005384 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5385 UnsignedLongTy,
5386 UnsignedLongTy,
5387 };
5388
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005389 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005390 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005391 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005392 };
5393
5394 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005395 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5396 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005397 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5398 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005399 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005400 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005401 }
5402
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005403 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005404
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005405 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005406
5407 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5408}
5409
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005410QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005411 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
5412 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5413
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005414 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005415 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005416 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
5417 RD->startDefinition();
5418
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005419 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5420 UnsignedLongTy,
5421 UnsignedLongTy,
5422 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
5423 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
5424 };
5425
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005426 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005427 "reserved",
5428 "Size",
5429 "CopyFuncPtr",
5430 "DestroyFuncPtr"
5431 };
5432
5433 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005434 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5435 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005436 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5437 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005438 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005439 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005440 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005441 }
5442
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005443 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005444
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005445 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005446 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5447}
5448
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005449/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
5450/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
5451/// in buildByrefHelpers.
5452bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
5453 const VarDecl *D) {
5454 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
5455 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
5456 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
5457
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005458 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00005459 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005460
5461 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
5462
5463 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
5464
5465 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
5466 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005467 switch (lifetime) {
5468 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
5469
5470 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
5471 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
5472 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
5473 return false;
5474
5475 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
5476 // byref routines.
5477 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
5478 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
5479 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
5480 return true;
5481 }
5482 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
5483 }
5484 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
5485 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005486}
5487
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005488bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
5489 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
5490 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
5491
5492 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
5493 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
5494 return false;
5495
5496 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00005497 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005498 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
5499 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005500 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
5501 // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
5502 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
5503 // The MRR rule.
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005504 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005505 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005506 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005507 }
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005508 return true;
5509}
5510
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005511TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
5512 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005513 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
5514 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005515 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
5516}
5517
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005518// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
5519// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00005520static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005521 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00005522 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
5523 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005524
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005525 return false;
5526}
5527
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005528/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005529/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005530CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005531 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
5532 return CharUnits::Zero();
5533
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005534 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005535
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005536 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00005537 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005538 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005539 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
5540 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005541 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005542 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005543}
5544
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005545bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00005546 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
5547 VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
David Majnemerfac52432015-10-19 23:22:49 +00005548 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5549 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005550}
5551
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005552ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind
5553ASTContext::getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl *VD) const {
5554 if (!VD->isInline())
5555 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None;
5556
5557 // In almost all cases, it's a weak definition.
5558 auto *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
5559 if (!First->isConstexpr() || First->isInlineSpecified() ||
5560 !VD->isStaticDataMember())
5561 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak;
5562
5563 // If there's a file-context declaration in this translation unit, it's a
5564 // non-discardable definition.
5565 for (auto *D : VD->redecls())
5566 if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFileContext())
5567 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong;
5568
5569 // If we've not seen one yet, we don't know.
5570 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown;
5571}
5572
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005573static inline
5574std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5575 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005576}
5577
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005578/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005579/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005580std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5581 std::string S;
5582
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005583 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5584 QualType BlockTy =
5585 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5586 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005587 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005588 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5589 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5590 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005591 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005592 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005593 // Compute size of all parameters.
5594 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5595 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5596 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005597 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5598 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005599 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005600 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005601 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00005602 if (sz.isZero())
5603 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005604 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005605 ParmOffset += sz;
5606 }
5607 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005608 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005609 // Block pointer and offset.
5610 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005611
5612 // Argument types.
5613 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005614 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005615 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5616 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5617 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5618 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5619 // elements.
5620 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5621 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5622 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5623 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005624 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005625 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5626 S, true /*Extended*/);
5627 else
5628 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005629 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005630 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005631 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005632
5633 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005634}
5635
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005636std::string
5637ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl) const {
5638 std::string S;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005639 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005640 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005641 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5642 // Compute size of all parameters.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005643 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005644 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005645 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005646 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005647 continue;
5648
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005649 assert(sz.isPositive() &&
5650 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005651 ParmOffset += sz;
5652 }
5653 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5654 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5655
5656 // Argument types.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005657 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005658 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5659 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5660 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5661 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5662 // elements.
5663 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5664 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5665 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5666 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5667 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5668 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5669 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5670 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005671
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005672 return S;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005673}
5674
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005675/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5676/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5677/// block object types.
5678void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5679 QualType T, std::string& S,
5680 bool Extended) const {
5681 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5682 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5683 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005684 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005685 true /*OutermostType*/,
5686 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
5687 false /*StructField*/,
5688 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5689 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5690}
5691
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005692/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005693/// declaration.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005694std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
5695 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005696 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005697 // Encode return type.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005698 std::string S;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005699 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5700 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005701 // Compute size of all parameters.
5702 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5703 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5704 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005705 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005706 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
5707 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005708 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005709 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005710 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00005711 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005712 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005713 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005714 continue;
5715
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005716 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5717 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005718 ParmOffset += sz;
5719 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005720 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005721 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005722 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005723
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005724 // Argument types.
5725 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005726 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00005727 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00005728 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005729 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00005730 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005731 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5732 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5733 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00005734 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00005735 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5736 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5737 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005738 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5739 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005740 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005741 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005742 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005743
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005744 return S;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005745}
5746
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005747ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
5748ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5749 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5750 const Decl *Container) const {
5751 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005752 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005753 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5754 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00005755 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5756 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5757 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005758 } else {
5759 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5760 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5761 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5762 return PID;
5763 }
5764 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005765}
5766
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005767/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005768/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005769/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5770/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005771/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5772/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5773/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5774/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5775/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005776/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5777/// @code
5778/// enum PropertyAttributes {
5779/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
5780/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5781/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5782/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5783/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5784/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5785/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00005786/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00005787/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5788/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5789/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5790/// };
5791/// @endcode
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005792std::string
5793ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5794 const Decl *Container) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005795 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5796 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005797 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005798
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00005799 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5800 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5801 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5802 Dynamic = true;
5803 else
5804 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005805 }
5806
5807 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005808 std::string S = "T";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005809
5810 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005811 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5812 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005813 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005814
5815 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5816 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00005817 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5818 S += ",C";
5819 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5820 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00005821 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5822 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005823 } else {
5824 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5825 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5826 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005827 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00005828 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005829 }
5830 }
5831
5832 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5833 // are "dynamic by default".
5834 if (Dynamic)
5835 S += ",D";
5836
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005837 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5838 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005839
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005840 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5841 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005842 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005843 }
5844
5845 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5846 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00005847 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005848 }
5849
5850 if (SynthesizePID) {
5851 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5852 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00005853 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005854 }
5855
5856 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005857 return S;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00005858}
5859
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005860/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005861/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5862/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005863/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5864///
5865void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005866 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005867 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005868 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005869 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005870 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005871 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005872 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5873 }
5874 }
5875}
5876
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005877void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005878 const FieldDecl *Field,
5879 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005880 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5881 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5882 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5883 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005884 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00005885 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5886 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005887}
5888
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00005889void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5890 std::string& S) const {
5891 // Encode result type.
5892 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5893 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5894 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5895 true /* outermost type */,
5896 true /* encoding property */);
5897}
5898
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005899static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5900 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5901 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005902 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5903 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5904 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5905 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005906 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005907 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005908 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005909 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5910 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005911 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005912 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5913 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5914 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5915 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5916 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005917 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5918 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005919 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5920 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005921 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005922 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5923 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5924 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5925 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005926 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005927 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5928
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005929 case BuiltinType::Float128:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005930 case BuiltinType::Half:
5931 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5932 return ' ';
5933
5934 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5935 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5936 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5937 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5938
5939 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00005940#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
5941 case BuiltinType::Id:
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00005942#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005943 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00005944 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
5945 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00005946 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005947 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005948 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5949#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5950#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5951 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5952#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5953 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005954 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005955 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005956}
5957
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005958static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5959 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5960
5961 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5962 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5963 return 'i';
5964
5965 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005966 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5967 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005968}
5969
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005970static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005971 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005972 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005973 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005974 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5975 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5976 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5977 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5978 //
5979 // struct
5980 // {
5981 // int integer;
5982 // int flags:2;
5983 // };
5984 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5985 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5986 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5987 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5988 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005989 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005990 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5991 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005992 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005993 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5994 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005995 else {
5996 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5997 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5998 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005999 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006000 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00006001}
6002
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00006003// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006004void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
6005 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
6006 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00006007 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006008 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006009 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006010 bool StructField,
6011 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006012 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006013 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
6014 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006015 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
6016 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
6017 case Type::Builtin:
6018 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006019 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006020 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006021 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
6022 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
6023 else
6024 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006025 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006026
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006027 case Type::Complex: {
6028 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00006029 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006030 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006031 return;
6032 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006033
6034 case Type::Atomic: {
6035 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
6036 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006037 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006038 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00006039 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006040
6041 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
6042 case Type::Pointer:
6043 case Type::LValueReference:
6044 case Type::RValueReference: {
6045 QualType PointeeTy;
6046 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
6047 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
6048 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
6049 S += ':';
6050 return;
6051 }
6052 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
6053 } else {
6054 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
6055 }
6056
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006057 bool isReadOnly = false;
6058 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
6059 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
6060 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006061 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00006062 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006063 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
6064 isReadOnly = true;
6065 S += 'r';
6066 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00006067 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006068 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006069 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
6070 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006071 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
6072 isReadOnly = true;
6073 S += 'r';
6074 }
6075 }
6076 if (isReadOnly) {
6077 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
6078 // combinations need to be rearranged.
6079 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006080 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00006081 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006082 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006083
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006084 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
6085 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
6086 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00006087 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006088 S += '*';
6089 return;
6090 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006091 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00006092 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
6093 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
6094 S += '#';
6095 return;
6096 }
6097 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
6098 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
6099 S += '@';
6100 return;
6101 }
6102 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006103 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006104 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006105 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
6106
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006107 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006108 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
6109 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006110 return;
6111 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006112
6113 case Type::ConstantArray:
6114 case Type::IncompleteArray:
6115 case Type::VariableArray: {
6116 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
6117
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006118 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006119 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
6120 S += '^';
6121
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006122 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006123 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
6124 } else {
6125 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006126
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00006127 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
6128 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
6129 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006130 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006131 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
6132 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006133 S += '0';
6134 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006135
6136 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006137 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
6138 false, false, false, false, false, false,
6139 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006140 S += ']';
6141 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006142 return;
6143 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006144
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006145 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
6146 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00006147 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006148 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006149
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006150 case Type::Record: {
6151 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006152 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006153 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
6154 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
6155 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006156 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
6157 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
6158 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00006159 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
6160 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00006161 TemplateArgs.asArray(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00006162 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006163 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006164 } else {
6165 S += '?';
6166 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00006167 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006168 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006169 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006170 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006171 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006172 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006173 if (FD) {
6174 S += '"';
6175 S += Field->getNameAsString();
6176 S += '"';
6177 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006178
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006179 // Special case bit-fields.
6180 if (Field->isBitField()) {
6181 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006182 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006183 } else {
6184 QualType qt = Field->getType();
6185 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6186 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
6187 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
6188 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006189 /*StructField*/true,
6190 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006191 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006192 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006193 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00006194 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006195 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006196 return;
6197 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006198
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006199 case Type::BlockPointer: {
6200 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00006201 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006202 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006203 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006204
6205 S += '<';
6206 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006207 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6208 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
6209 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006210 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
6211 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006212 // Block self
6213 S += "@?";
6214 // Block parameters
6215 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00006216 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
6217 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6218 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
6219 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006220 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
6221 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006222 }
6223 S += '>';
6224 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006225 return;
6226 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006227
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00006228 case Type::ObjCObject: {
6229 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
6230 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
6231 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
6232 S += "{objc_object=}";
6233 return;
6234 }
6235 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
6236 S += "{objc_class=}";
6237 return;
6238 }
6239 }
6240
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006241 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
6242 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006243 // @encode(class_name)
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006244 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006245 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006246 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Akira Hatanakafd0fb202016-08-17 19:42:22 +00006247 if (ExpandStructures) {
6248 S += '=';
6249 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6250 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6251 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6252 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
6253 if (Field->isBitField())
6254 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
6255 else
6256 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
6257 false, false, false, false, false,
6258 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
6259 NotEncodedT);
6260 }
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006261 }
6262 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006263 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006264 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006265
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006266 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
6267 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006268 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
6269 S += '@';
6270 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006271 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006272
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00006273 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
6274 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
6275 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
6276 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006277 S += '#';
6278 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006279 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006280
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006281 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006282 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006283 ExpandPointedToStructures,
6284 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006285 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006286 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
6287 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006288 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006289 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006290 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006291 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006292 S += '>';
6293 }
6294 S += '"';
6295 }
6296 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006297 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006298
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006299 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
6300 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006301 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
6302 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006303 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006304 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006305 // {...};
6306 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006307 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00006308 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006309 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
6310 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6311 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6312 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6313 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
6314 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006315 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006316 S += '}';
6317 return;
6318 }
6319 }
6320 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006321 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
6322 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006323 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006324 false, false, false, false, false,
6325 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006326 return;
6327 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006328
6329 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006330 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
6331 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006332 S += '"';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006333 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006334 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006335 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006336 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006337 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006338 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006339 S += '"';
6340 }
6341 return;
6342 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006343
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00006344 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006345 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
6346 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006347 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
6348 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006349 case Type::Vector:
6350 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006351 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
6352 { if (NotEncodedT)
6353 *NotEncodedT = T;
6354 return;
6355 }
6356
6357 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
6358 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006359 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00006360 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006361 return;
6362
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00006363 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006364#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6365#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6366#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6367 case Type::KIND:
6368#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6369 case Type::KIND:
6370#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6371 case Type::KIND:
6372#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
6373 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00006374 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006375 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006376}
6377
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006378void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
6379 std::string &S,
6380 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006381 bool includeVBases,
6382 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006383 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
6384 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis785705b2016-01-16 00:20:02 +00006385 if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006386 return;
6387
6388 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
6389 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
6390 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
6391
6392 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00006393 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
6394 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
6395 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006396 if (base->isEmpty())
6397 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006398 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006399 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
6400 std::make_pair(offs, base));
6401 }
6402 }
6403 }
6404
6405 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006406 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006407 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
6408 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006409 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
6410 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006411 }
6412
6413 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00006414 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
6415 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006416 if (base->isEmpty())
6417 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006418 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00006419 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
6420 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00006421 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
6422 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006423 }
6424 }
6425
6426 CharUnits size;
6427 if (CXXRec) {
6428 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
6429 } else {
6430 size = layout.getSize();
6431 }
6432
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006433#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006434 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006435#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006436 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
6437 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
6438
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00006439 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
6440 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006441 if (FD) {
6442 S += "\"_vptr$";
6443 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
6444 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
6445 S += recname;
6446 S += '"';
6447 }
6448 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006449#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006450 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006451#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006452 }
6453
6454 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
6455 // Mark the end of the structure.
6456 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
6457 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006458 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006459 }
6460
6461 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006462#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006463 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006464 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
6465 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
6466 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
6467 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
6468 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
6469 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
6470 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
6471 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
6472 // longer then though.
6473 CurOffs += padding;
6474 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006475#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006476
6477 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006478 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006479 break; // reached end of structure.
6480
6481 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
6482 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
6483 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
6484 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
6485 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006486 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
6487 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006488 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006489#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006490 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006491#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006492 } else {
6493 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
6494 if (FD) {
6495 S += '"';
6496 S += field->getNameAsString();
6497 S += '"';
6498 }
6499
6500 if (field->isBitField()) {
6501 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006502#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006503 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006504#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006505 } else {
6506 QualType qt = field->getType();
6507 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6508 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
6509 /*OutermostType*/false,
6510 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006511 /*StructField*/true,
6512 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006513#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006514 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006515#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006516 }
6517 }
6518 }
6519}
6520
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006521void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00006522 std::string& S) const {
6523 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
6524 S += 'n';
6525 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
6526 S += 'N';
6527 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
6528 S += 'o';
6529 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
6530 S += 'O';
6531 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
6532 S += 'R';
6533 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
6534 S += 'V';
6535}
6536
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006537TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
6538 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006539 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006540 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006541 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006542 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006543 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00006544}
6545
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006546TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
6547 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006548 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
6549 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006550 }
6551 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00006552}
6553
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006554TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
6555 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00006556 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, { });
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006557 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006558 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006559 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006560 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00006561}
6562
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006563ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
6564 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
6565 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
6566 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6567 SourceLocation(),
6568 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Douglas Gregor85f3f952015-07-07 03:57:15 +00006569 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006570 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006571 SourceLocation(), true);
6572 }
6573
6574 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
6575}
6576
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006577//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6578// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
6579//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6580
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006581static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6582 StringRef Name) {
6583 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006584 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006585 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
6586}
6587
6588static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6589 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
6590}
6591
6592static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6593 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006594}
6595
6596static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6597 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006598 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6599 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006600}
6601
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006602static TypedefDecl *
6603CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006604 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006605 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006606 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6607 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6608 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6609 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6610 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006611 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006612 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006613 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006614 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006615 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006616 }
6617
6618 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6619
6620 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6621 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6622 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6623
6624 // void *__stack;
6625 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6626 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6627
6628 // void *__gr_top;
6629 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6630 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6631
6632 // void *__vr_top;
6633 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6634 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6635
6636 // int __gr_offs;
6637 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6638 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6639
6640 // int __vr_offs;
6641 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6642 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6643
6644 // Create fields
6645 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6646 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6647 VaListTagDecl,
6648 SourceLocation(),
6649 SourceLocation(),
6650 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006651 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6652 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006653 /*Mutable=*/false,
6654 ICIS_NoInit);
6655 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6656 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6657 }
6658 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006659 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006660 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006661
6662 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006663 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006664}
6665
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006666static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6667 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6668 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6669
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006670 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006671 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6672
6673 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6674 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6675 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6676
6677 // unsigned char gpr;
6678 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6679 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6680
6681 // unsigned char fpr;
6682 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6683 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6684
6685 // unsigned short reserved;
6686 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
6687 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
6688
6689 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6690 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6691 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
6692
6693 // void* reg_save_area;
6694 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6695 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
6696
6697 // Create fields
6698 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6699 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
6700 SourceLocation(),
6701 SourceLocation(),
6702 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006703 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6704 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006705 /*Mutable=*/false,
6706 ICIS_NoInit);
6707 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6708 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6709 }
6710 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006711 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006712 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6713
6714 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006715 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6716 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6717
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006718 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6719 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6720
6721 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6722 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6723 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6724 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6725 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006726 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006727}
6728
6729static TypedefDecl *
6730CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006731 // struct __va_list_tag {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006732 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006733 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006734 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6735
6736 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6737 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6738 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6739
6740 // unsigned gp_offset;
6741 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6742 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6743
6744 // unsigned fp_offset;
6745 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6746 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6747
6748 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6749 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6750 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6751
6752 // void* reg_save_area;
6753 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6754 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6755
6756 // Create fields
6757 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6758 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6759 VaListTagDecl,
6760 SourceLocation(),
6761 SourceLocation(),
6762 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006763 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6764 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006765 /*Mutable=*/false,
6766 ICIS_NoInit);
6767 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6768 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6769 }
6770 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006771 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006772 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6773
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006774 // };
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006775
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006776 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006777 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006778 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6779 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006780 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006781}
6782
6783static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6784 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6785 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
Yaron Kerene0bcdd42016-10-08 06:45:10 +00006786 QualType IntArrayType =
6787 Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006788 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006789}
6790
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006791static TypedefDecl *
6792CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006793 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006794 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006795 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6796 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6797 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6798 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6799 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6800 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6801 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006802 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006803 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006804 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006805 }
6806
6807 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6808
6809 // void * __ap;
6810 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6811 VaListDecl,
6812 SourceLocation(),
6813 SourceLocation(),
6814 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6815 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006816 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6817 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006818 /*Mutable=*/false,
6819 ICIS_NoInit);
6820 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6821 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6822
6823 // };
6824 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
Oleg Ranevskyyb88d2472016-03-30 21:30:30 +00006825 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListDecl;
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006826
6827 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006828 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6829 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006830}
6831
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006832static TypedefDecl *
6833CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006834 // struct __va_list_tag {
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006835 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006836 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006837 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6838
6839 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6840 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6841 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6842
6843 // long __gpr;
6844 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6845 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6846
6847 // long __fpr;
6848 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6849 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6850
6851 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6852 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6853 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6854
6855 // void *__reg_save_area;
6856 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6857 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6858
6859 // Create fields
6860 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6861 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6862 VaListTagDecl,
6863 SourceLocation(),
6864 SourceLocation(),
6865 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006866 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6867 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006868 /*Mutable=*/false,
6869 ICIS_NoInit);
6870 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6871 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6872 }
6873 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006874 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006875 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006876
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006877 // };
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006878
6879 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6880 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006881 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
6882 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006883
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006884 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006885}
6886
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006887static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6888 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6889 switch (Kind) {
6890 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6891 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6892 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6893 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006894 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6895 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006896 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6897 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6898 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6899 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6900 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6901 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006902 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6903 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006904 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6905 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006906 }
6907
6908 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6909}
6910
6911TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006912 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006913 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006914 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6915 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006916
6917 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6918}
6919
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006920Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
6921 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006922 // declaration.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006923 if (!VaListTagDecl)
6924 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006925
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006926 return VaListTagDecl;
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006927}
6928
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006929TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
6930 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
6931 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
6932
6933 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
6934}
6935
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006936void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006937 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006938 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006939
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006940 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006941}
6942
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006943/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6944/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006945TemplateName
6946ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6947 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006948 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6949 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6950
6951 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6952 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6953 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6954
6955 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006956 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006957 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6958 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6959 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6960 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6961 *Storage++ = D;
6962 }
6963
6964 return TemplateName(OT);
6965}
6966
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006967/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6968/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006969TemplateName
6970ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6971 bool TemplateKeyword,
6972 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006973 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6974
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006975 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006976 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6977 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6978
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006979 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006980 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6981 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6982 if (!QTN) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00006983 QTN = new (*this, alignof(QualifiedTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006984 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006985 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6986 }
6987
6988 return TemplateName(QTN);
6989}
6990
6991/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6992/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006993TemplateName
6994ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6995 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006996 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006997 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006998
6999 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7000 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
7001
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007002 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007003 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
7004 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7005
7006 if (QTN)
7007 return TemplateName(QTN);
7008
7009 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
7010 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007011 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007012 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007013 } else {
7014 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007015 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007016 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007017 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
7018 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7019 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
7020 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007021 }
7022
7023 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7024 return TemplateName(QTN);
7025}
7026
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007027/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
7028/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
7029TemplateName
7030ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007031 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007032 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
7033 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
7034
7035 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7036 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007037
7038 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007039 DependentTemplateName *QTN
7040 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007041
7042 if (QTN)
7043 return TemplateName(QTN);
7044
7045 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
7046 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007047 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007048 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007049 } else {
7050 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007051 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007052 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007053
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007054 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
7055 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7056 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
7057 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007058 }
7059
7060 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7061 return TemplateName(QTN);
7062}
7063
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007064TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007065ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
7066 TemplateName replacement) const {
7067 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7068 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007069
7070 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007071 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
7072 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
7073
7074 if (!subst) {
7075 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
7076 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
7077 }
7078
7079 return TemplateName(subst);
7080}
7081
7082TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007083ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
7084 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
7085 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
7086 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7087 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007088
7089 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007090 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
7091 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7092
7093 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007094 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007095 ArgPack.pack_size(),
7096 ArgPack.pack_begin());
7097 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
7098 }
7099
7100 return TemplateName(Subst);
7101}
7102
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007103/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00007104/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
7105/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007106CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007107 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007108 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00007109 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
7110 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007111 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
7112 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
7113 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
7114 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
7115 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
7116 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
7117 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
7118 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
7119 }
7120
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007121 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007122}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00007123
7124//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7125// Type Predicates.
7126//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7127
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007128/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
7129/// garbage collection attribute.
7130///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007131Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007132 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007133 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
7134
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007135 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007136 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
7137
7138 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
7139 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
7140 // as __strong.
7141 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
7142 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
7143 return Qualifiers::Strong;
7144 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
7145 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
7146 } else {
7147 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
7148 // pointer.
7149#ifndef NDEBUG
7150 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
7151 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
7152 CT = AT->getElementType();
7153 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
7154#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007155 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00007156 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007157}
7158
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007159//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7160// Type Compatibility Testing
7161//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00007162
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007163/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007164/// compatible.
7165static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
7166 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00007167 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007168 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007169 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007170}
7171
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007172bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
7173 QualType SecondVec) {
7174 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
7175 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
7176
7177 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
7178 return true;
7179
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007180 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
7181 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007182 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
7183 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007184 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007185 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007186 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7187 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
7188 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7189 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007190 return true;
7191
7192 return false;
7193}
7194
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007195//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7196// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
7197//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7198
7199/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
7200/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007201bool
7202ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
7203 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00007204 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007205 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00007206 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
7207 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007208 return true;
7209 return false;
7210}
7211
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00007212/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
7213/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007214bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
7215 QualType rhs) {
7216 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7217 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7218 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
7219
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007220 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007221 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007222 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007223 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
7224 match = true;
7225 break;
7226 }
7227 }
7228 if (!match)
7229 return false;
7230 }
7231 return true;
7232}
7233
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007234/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
7235/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
7236bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7237 bool compare) {
7238 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007239 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007240 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
7241 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007242 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007243 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
7244 return true;
7245
7246 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007247 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007248
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007249 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007250
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007251 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007252 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007253 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7254 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007255 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007256 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7257 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7258 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007259 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007260 return false;
7261 }
7262 }
7263 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
7264 return true;
7265 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007266 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007267 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007268 bool match = false;
7269
7270 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7271 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7272 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007273 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007274 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7275 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7276 match = true;
7277 break;
7278 }
7279 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007280 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007281 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7282 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007283 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007284 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7285 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7286 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007287 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007288 match = true;
7289 break;
7290 }
7291 }
7292 }
7293 if (!match)
7294 return false;
7295 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007296
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007297 return true;
7298 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007299
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007300 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
7301 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
7302
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007303 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007304 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007305 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007306 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007307 bool match = false;
7308
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007309 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007310 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7311 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007312 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
7313 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007314 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007315 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7316 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7317 match = true;
7318 break;
7319 }
7320 }
7321 if (!match)
7322 return false;
7323 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007324
7325 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
7326 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
7327 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
7328 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
7329 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
7330 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
7331 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
7332 // assume that it is mismatch.
7333 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
7334 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007335 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007336 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007337 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007338 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7339 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7340 match = true;
7341 break;
7342 }
7343 }
7344 if (!match)
7345 return false;
7346 }
7347 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007348 return true;
7349 }
7350 return false;
7351}
7352
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007353/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007354/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
7355/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
7356///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007357bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7358 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007359 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7360 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7361
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00007362 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007363 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
7364 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007365 return true;
7366
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007367 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7368 // __kindof types.
7369 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7370 if (succeeded)
7371 return true;
7372
7373 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
7374 return false;
7375
7376 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7377 // we can assign the other way.
7378 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7379 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
7380 };
7381
7382 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
7383 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7384 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7385 false));
7386 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007387
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007388 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
7389 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7390 QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
7391 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007392
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007393 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007394 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
7395 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
7396 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007397
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007398 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007399}
7400
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007401/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00007402/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007403/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
7404/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
7405/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
7406bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7407 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007408 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
7409 bool BlockReturnType) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007410
7411 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7412 // __kindof types.
7413 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7414 if (succeeded)
7415 return true;
7416
7417 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
7418 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
7419 return false;
7420
7421 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7422 // we can assign the other way.
7423 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7424 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7425 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7426 BlockReturnType);
7427 };
7428
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007429 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007430 return true;
7431
7432 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007433 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
7434 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007435 }
7436
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007437 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007438 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7439 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7440 false));
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007441
7442 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7443 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7444 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
7445 if (LHS != RHS) {
7446 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007447 return finish(BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007448 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007449 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007450 }
7451 else
7452 return true;
7453 }
7454 return false;
7455}
7456
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007457/// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
7458/// llvm::array_pod_sort.
7459static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
7460 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
7461 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
7462
7463}
7464
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007465/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007466/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
7467/// the given common base.
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007468/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
7469/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
7470static
7471void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007472 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007473 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7474 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007475 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007476
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007477 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7478 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7479 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
7480 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007481
7482 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
7483 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
7484
7485 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7486 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
7487 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007488 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007489
7490 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
7491 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
7492
7493 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
7494 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
7495
7496 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7497 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
7498 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007499 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007500
7501 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
7502 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
7503
7504 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
7505 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
7506 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
7507 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
7508 }
7509
7510 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
7511 // the protocols within the intersection.
7512 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
7513 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
7514
7515 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
7516 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
7517 IntersectionSet.erase(
7518 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
7519 IntersectionSet.end(),
7520 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
7521 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
7522 }),
7523 IntersectionSet.end());
7524 }
7525
7526 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
7527 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
7528 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007529}
7530
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007531/// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
7532static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
7533 QualType rhs) {
7534 // Common case: two object pointers.
7535 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7536 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7537 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
7538 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
7539
7540 // Two block pointers.
7541 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7542 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7543 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
7544 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
7545
7546 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
7547 // acceptable.
7548 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
7549 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
7550 return true;
7551
7552 return false;
7553}
7554
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007555// Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007556static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
7557 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
7558 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007559 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
7560 bool stripKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007561 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
7562 return false;
7563
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007564 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007565 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007566 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7567 continue;
7568
7569 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
7570 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007571 if (!stripKindOf ||
7572 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
7573 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
7574 return false;
7575 }
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007576 break;
7577
7578 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
7579 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7580 return false;
7581 break;
7582
7583 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
7584 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7585 return false;
7586 break;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007587 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007588 }
7589
7590 return true;
7591}
7592
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007593QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007594 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7595 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007596 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7597 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7598 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7599 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007600
7601 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007602 return QualType();
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007603
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007604 // When either LHS or RHS is a kindof type, we should return a kindof type.
7605 // For example, for common base of kindof(ASub1) and kindof(ASub2), we return
7606 // kindof(A).
7607 bool anyKindOf = LHS->isKindOfType() || RHS->isKindOfType();
7608
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007609 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7610 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7611 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7612 LHSAncestors;
7613 while (true) {
7614 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7615 // path from the LHS to the root.
7616 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007617
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007618 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7619 // Get the type arguments.
7620 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7621 bool anyChanges = false;
7622 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7623 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007624 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7625 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007626 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007627 return QualType();
7628 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7629 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7630 // arguments.
7631 LHSTypeArgs = { };
7632 anyChanges = true;
7633 }
7634
7635 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007636 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007637 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7638 Protocols);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007639 if (!Protocols.empty())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007640 anyChanges = true;
7641
7642 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007643 // If we need to return a kindof type but LHS is not a kindof type, we
7644 // build a new result type.
7645 if (anyChanges || LHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007646 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007647 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007648 anyKindOf || LHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007649 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7650 }
7651
7652 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007653 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007654
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007655 // Find the superclass.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007656 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7657 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7658 break;
7659
7660 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7661 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007662
7663 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7664 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7665 while (true) {
7666 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7667 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7668 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7669
7670 // Get the type arguments.
7671 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7672 bool anyChanges = false;
7673 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7674 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007675 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7676 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007677 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007678 return QualType();
7679 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7680 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7681 // arguments.
7682 RHSTypeArgs = { };
7683 anyChanges = true;
7684 }
7685
7686 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
7687 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
7688 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7689 Protocols);
7690 if (!Protocols.empty())
7691 anyChanges = true;
7692
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007693 // If we need to return a kindof type but RHS is not a kindof type, we
7694 // build a new result type.
7695 if (anyChanges || RHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007696 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007697 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007698 anyKindOf || RHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007699 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7700 }
7701
7702 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
7703 }
7704
7705 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
7706 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
7707 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
7708 break;
7709
7710 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7711 }
7712
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007713 return QualType();
7714}
7715
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007716bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
7717 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
7718 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
7719 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
7720
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007721 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
7722 // the LHS.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007723 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
7724 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
7725 if (!IsSuperClass)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007726 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007727
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007728 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
7729 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
7730 // LHS).
7731 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007732 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
7733 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
7734 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
7735 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
7736 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
7737 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
7738 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
7739 // qualifiers.
7740 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007741 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007742 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
7743 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00007744 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00007745
7746 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
7747 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
7748 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
7749 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
7750 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
7751 break;
7752 }
7753 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
7754 return false;
7755 }
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007756 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007757
7758 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
7759 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
7760 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
7761 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
7762 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
7763 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
7764 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7765
7766 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007767 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007768 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7769 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007770 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007771 return false;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007772 }
7773 }
7774
7775 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007776}
7777
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007778bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7779 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007780 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7781 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007782
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007783 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007784 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007785
7786 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
7787 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00007788}
7789
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00007790bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
7791 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
7792 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7793 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
7794}
7795
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007796/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007797/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007798/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007799/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007800bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7801 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007802 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007803 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00007804
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007805 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007806}
7807
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007808bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00007809 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00007810}
7811
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007812bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7813 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
7814}
7815
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007816/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
7817/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
7818/// QualType()
7819QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
7820 bool OfBlockPointer,
7821 bool Unqualified) {
7822 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
7823 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
7824 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00007825 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
7826 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007827 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7828 if (!MT.isNull())
7829 return MT;
7830 }
7831 }
7832 }
7833
7834 return QualType();
7835}
7836
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007837/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
7838/// parameter types
7839QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7840 bool OfBlockPointer,
7841 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00007842 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
7843 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
7844 // type is compatible with a union member
7845 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
7846 Unqualified);
7847 if (!lmerge.isNull())
7848 return lmerge;
7849
7850 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
7851 Unqualified);
7852 if (!rmerge.isNull())
7853 return rmerge;
7854
7855 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7856}
7857
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007858QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007859 bool OfBlockPointer,
7860 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007861 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7862 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007863 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
7864 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007865 bool allLTypes = true;
7866 bool allRTypes = true;
7867
7868 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007869 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007870 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007871 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
7872 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007873 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
7874 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
7875 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007876 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00007877 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007878 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007879 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007880 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007881 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007882
7883 if (Unqualified)
7884 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
7885
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00007886 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
7887 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007888 if (Unqualified) {
7889 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7890 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7891 }
7892
7893 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007894 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007895 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007896 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007897
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00007898 // FIXME: double check this
7899 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7900 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7901 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007902 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7903 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007904
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007905 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00007906 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00007907 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007908
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007909 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00007910 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7911 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007912 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7913 return QualType();
7914
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007915 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7916 return QualType();
7917
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007918 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7919 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007920
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00007921 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7922 allLTypes = false;
7923 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7924 allRTypes = false;
7925
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007926 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007927
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007928 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007929 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7930 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007931 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
7932 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007933 return QualType();
7934
7935 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7936 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7937 return QualType();
7938
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00007939 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7940 return QualType();
7941
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00007942 if (!doFunctionTypesMatchOnExtParameterInfos(rproto, lproto))
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007943 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007944
7945 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007946 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007947 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7948 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7949 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7950 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7951 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7952 if (paramType.isNull())
7953 return QualType();
7954
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007955 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007956 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7957
7958 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007959 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007960 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7961 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007962 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007963
7964 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007965 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007966 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007967 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007968 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007969
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007970 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7971 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007972
7973 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7974 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007975 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007976 }
7977
7978 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7979 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7980
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007981 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007982 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00007983 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007984 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7985 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7986 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7987 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7988 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7989 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007990 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7991 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00007992
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007993 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007994 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00007995 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7996 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7997 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007998 return QualType();
7999 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008000
8001 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
8002 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008003 return QualType();
8004 }
8005
8006 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8007 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008008
8009 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
8010 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008011 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008012 }
8013
8014 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8015 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008016 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008017}
8018
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008019/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
8020static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
8021 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
8022 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
8023 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
8024 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
8025 // type.
8026 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8027 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
8028 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
8029 return other;
8030
8031 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
8032 // integral type of the same size.
8033 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
8034 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
8035 return other;
8036
8037 return QualType();
8038}
8039
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008040QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008041 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008042 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00008043 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
8044 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
8045 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00008046 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
8047 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008048 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
8049 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008050
8051 if (Unqualified) {
8052 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
8053 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
8054 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008055
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008056 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
8057 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
8058
8059 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
8060 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
8061 return LHS;
8062
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008063 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00008064 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8065 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008066 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
Yaxun Liua1a87ad2016-04-12 19:43:36 +00008067 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
Yaxun Liuab933942016-04-28 17:34:57 +00008068 if (LHSCan.getUnqualifiedType() != RHSCan.getUnqualifiedType() ||
Yaxun Liua1a87ad2016-04-12 19:43:36 +00008069 LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers())
8070 return QualType();
8071 if (LQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(RQuals))
8072 return LHS;
8073 if (RQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(LQuals))
8074 return RHS;
8075 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008076 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
8077 // mismatch.
8078 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008079 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
8080 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008081 return QualType();
8082
8083 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
8084 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
8085 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
8086 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8087 // qualified __strong.
8088 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8089 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8090 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8091
8092 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8093 return QualType();
8094
8095 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8096 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
8097 }
8098 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8099 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
8100 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008101 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008102 }
8103
8104 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008105
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00008106 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
8107 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008108
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008109 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
8110 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
8111 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
8112 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00008113
8114 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008115 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8116 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
8117 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8118 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008119
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008120 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
8121 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8122 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8123
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00008124 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
8125 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
8126 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008127
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008128 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008129 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008130 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
8131 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008132 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008133 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008134 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008135 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008136 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008137 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008138 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00008139 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
8140 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
8141 return LHS;
8142 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
8143 return RHS;
8144 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008145
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008146 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008147 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008148
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00008149 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008150 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008151#define TYPE(Class, Base)
8152#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00008153#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008154#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8155#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8156#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008157 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008158
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00008159 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00008160 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00008161 case Type::LValueReference:
8162 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008163 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008164 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008165
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008166 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008167 case Type::IncompleteArray:
8168 case Type::VariableArray:
8169 case Type::FunctionProto:
8170 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008171 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008172
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008173 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008174 {
8175 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008176 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8177 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008178 if (Unqualified) {
8179 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8180 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8181 }
8182 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
8183 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008184 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008185 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008186 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008187 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008188 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008189 return getPointerType(ResultType);
8190 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008191 case Type::BlockPointer:
8192 {
8193 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008194 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8195 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008196 if (Unqualified) {
8197 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8198 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8199 }
8200 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
8201 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008202 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8203 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8204 return LHS;
8205 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8206 return RHS;
8207 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
8208 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00008209 case Type::Atomic:
8210 {
8211 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
8212 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8213 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8214 if (Unqualified) {
8215 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8216 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8217 }
8218 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
8219 Unqualified);
8220 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8221 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8222 return LHS;
8223 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8224 return RHS;
8225 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
8226 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008227 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008228 {
8229 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
8230 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
8231 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
8232 return QualType();
8233
8234 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
8235 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008236 if (Unqualified) {
8237 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8238 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8239 }
8240
8241 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008242 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008243 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8244 return LHS;
8245 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8246 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008247 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
8248 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
8249 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
8250 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008251 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
8252 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008253 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8254 return LHS;
8255 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8256 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008257 if (LVAT) {
8258 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8259 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
8260 // has to be different.
8261 return LHS;
8262 }
8263 if (RVAT) {
8264 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8265 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
8266 // has to be different.
8267 return RHS;
8268 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008269 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
8270 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00008271 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
8272 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008273 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008274 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008275 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008276 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008277 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008278 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008279 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008280 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008281 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00008282 case Type::Complex:
8283 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
8284 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008285 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008286 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00008287 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
8288 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008289 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008290 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008291 case Type::ObjCObject: {
8292 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008293 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
8294 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008295 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8296 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8297 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00008298 return LHS;
8299
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008300 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00008301 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008302 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008303 if (OfBlockPointer) {
8304 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
8305 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008306 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8307 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008308 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008309 return QualType();
8310 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008311 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8312 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008313 return LHS;
8314
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00008315 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008316 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00008317 case Type::Pipe:
8318 {
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00008319 assert(LHS != RHS &&
8320 "Equivalent pipe types should have already been handled!");
8321 return QualType();
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00008322 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008323 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008324
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008325 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008326}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00008327
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008328bool ASTContext::doFunctionTypesMatchOnExtParameterInfos(
8329 const FunctionProtoType *firstFnType,
8330 const FunctionProtoType *secondFnType) {
8331 // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos,
8332 // we match if and only if they second type also doesn't have them.
8333 if (!firstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos())
8334 return !secondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
8335
8336 // Otherwise, we can only match if the second type has them.
8337 if (!secondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos())
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008338 return false;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008339
8340 auto firstEPI = firstFnType->getExtParameterInfos();
8341 auto secondEPI = secondFnType->getExtParameterInfos();
8342 assert(firstEPI.size() == secondEPI.size());
8343
8344 for (size_t i = 0, n = firstEPI.size(); i != n; ++i) {
8345 if (firstEPI[i] != secondEPI[i])
8346 return false;
8347 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008348 return true;
8349}
8350
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00008351void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
8352 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
8353}
8354
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008355/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
8356/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
8357/// return types.
8358QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8359 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
8360 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
8361 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
8362 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
8363 return LHS;
8364 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
8365 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
8366 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008367 QualType OldReturnType =
8368 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008369 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008370 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008371 QualType ResReturnType =
8372 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
8373 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
8374 return QualType();
8375 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
8376 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
8377 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
8378 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
8379 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008380 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
8381 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00008382 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008383 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008384 return ResultType;
8385 }
8386 }
8387 return QualType();
8388 }
8389
8390 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
8391 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8392 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8393 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
8394 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
8395 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
8396 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
8397 return QualType();
8398
8399 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
8400 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
8401 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
8402 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8403 // qualified __strong.
8404 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8405 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8406 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8407
8408 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8409 return QualType();
8410
8411 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
8412 return LHS;
8413 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
8414 return RHS;
8415 return QualType();
8416 }
8417
8418 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8419 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8420 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8421 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
8422 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
8423 return LHS;
8424 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
8425 return RHS;
8426 }
8427 return QualType();
8428}
8429
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00008430//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008431// Integer Predicates
8432//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00008433
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008434unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00008435 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00008436 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00008437 if (T->isBooleanType())
8438 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00008439 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008440 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
8441}
8442
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00008443QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00008444 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008445
8446 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
8447 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
8448 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008449 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008450
8451 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
8452 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008453 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008454
8455 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8456 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008457 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
8458 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
8459 case BuiltinType::SChar:
8460 return UnsignedCharTy;
8461 case BuiltinType::Short:
8462 return UnsignedShortTy;
8463 case BuiltinType::Int:
8464 return UnsignedIntTy;
8465 case BuiltinType::Long:
8466 return UnsignedLongTy;
8467 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
8468 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00008469 case BuiltinType::Int128:
8470 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008471 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008472 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008473 }
8474}
8475
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00008476ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00008477
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00008478void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
8479 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008480
8481//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8482// Builtin Type Computation
8483//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8484
8485/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008486/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
8487/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
8488/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
8489/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008490///
8491/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
8492/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008493static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008494 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008495 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008496 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008497 // Modifiers.
8498 int HowLong = 0;
8499 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008500 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008501
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008502 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008503 bool Done = false;
8504 while (!Done) {
8505 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008506 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008507 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008508 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008509 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008510 case 'S':
8511 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
8512 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
8513 Signed = true;
8514 break;
8515 case 'U':
8516 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008517 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008518 Unsigned = true;
8519 break;
8520 case 'L':
8521 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
8522 ++HowLong;
8523 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008524 case 'W':
8525 // This modifier represents int64 type.
8526 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
8527 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
8528 default:
8529 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
8530 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
8531 HowLong = 1;
8532 break;
8533 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
8534 HowLong = 2;
8535 break;
8536 }
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008537 }
8538 }
8539
8540 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008541
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008542 // Read the base type.
8543 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008544 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008545 case 'v':
8546 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8547 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
8548 Type = Context.VoidTy;
8549 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008550 case 'h':
8551 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008552 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008553 Type = Context.HalfTy;
8554 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008555 case 'f':
8556 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8557 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
8558 Type = Context.FloatTy;
8559 break;
8560 case 'd':
8561 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8562 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
8563 if (HowLong)
8564 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
8565 else
8566 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
8567 break;
8568 case 's':
8569 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
8570 if (Unsigned)
8571 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
8572 else
8573 Type = Context.ShortTy;
8574 break;
8575 case 'i':
8576 if (HowLong == 3)
8577 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
8578 else if (HowLong == 2)
8579 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
8580 else if (HowLong == 1)
8581 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
8582 else
8583 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
8584 break;
8585 case 'c':
8586 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
8587 if (Signed)
8588 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
8589 else if (Unsigned)
8590 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
8591 else
8592 Type = Context.CharTy;
8593 break;
8594 case 'b': // boolean
8595 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
8596 Type = Context.BoolTy;
8597 break;
8598 case 'z': // size_t.
8599 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
8600 Type = Context.getSizeType();
8601 break;
Richard Smith8110c9d2016-11-29 19:45:17 +00008602 case 'w': // wchar_t.
8603 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'w'!");
8604 Type = Context.getWideCharType();
8605 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008606 case 'F':
8607 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
8608 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00008609 case 'G':
8610 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
8611 break;
8612 case 'H':
8613 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
8614 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00008615 case 'M':
8616 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
8617 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008618 case 'a':
8619 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8620 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8621 break;
8622 case 'A':
8623 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
8624 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
8625 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
8626 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
8627 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
8628 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
8629 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
8630 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
8631 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8632 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008633 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008634 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008635 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008636 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008637 break;
8638 case 'V': {
8639 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008640 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8641 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008642 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008643
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008644 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
8645 RequiresICE, false);
8646 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008647
8648 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00008649 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008650 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008651 break;
8652 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00008653 case 'E': {
8654 char *End;
8655
8656 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8657 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
8658
8659 Str = End;
8660
8661 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8662 false);
8663 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
8664 break;
8665 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008666 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008667 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8668 false);
8669 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00008670 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
8671 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00008672 }
8673 case 'Y' : {
8674 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
8675 break;
8676 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008677 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00008678 Type = Context.getFILEType();
8679 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008680 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008681 return QualType();
8682 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008683 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00008684 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008685 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008686 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008687 else
8688 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
8689
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008690 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00008691 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00008692 return QualType();
8693 }
8694 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00008695 case 'K':
8696 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
8697 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
8698
8699 if (Type.isNull()) {
8700 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
8701 return QualType();
8702 }
8703 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00008704 case 'p':
8705 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
8706 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00008707 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008708
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008709 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
8710 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008711 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00008712 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008713 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
8714 case '*':
8715 case '&': {
8716 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
8717 // qualified with an address space.
8718 char *End;
8719 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8720 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
8721 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
8722 Str = End;
8723 }
8724 if (c == '*')
8725 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
8726 else
8727 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
8728 break;
8729 }
8730 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
8731 case 'C':
8732 Type = Type.withConst();
8733 break;
8734 case 'D':
8735 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
8736 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00008737 case 'R':
8738 Type = Type.withRestrict();
8739 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008740 }
8741 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008742
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008743 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008744 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008745
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008746 return Type;
8747}
8748
8749/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008750QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008751 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008752 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Eric Christopher02d5d862015-08-06 01:01:12 +00008753 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008754
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008755 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008756
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008757 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008758 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008759 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
8760 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008761 if (Error != GE_None)
8762 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008763
8764 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
8765
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008766 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008767 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008768 if (Error != GE_None)
8769 return QualType();
8770
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008771 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
8772 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
8773 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
8774 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
8775
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008776 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
8777 if (Ty->isArrayType())
8778 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008779
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008780 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
8781 }
8782
David Majnemerba3e5ec2015-03-13 18:26:17 +00008783 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
8784 return QualType();
8785
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008786 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
8787 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
8788
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008789 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008790 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
8791
8792 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
8793
Richard Smith836de6b2016-12-19 23:59:34 +00008794 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here.
8795 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008796 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00008797
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008798 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00008799 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
8800 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
Richard Smith391fb862016-10-18 07:13:55 +00008801 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(Id))
8802 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
8803 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_DynamicNone;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008804
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00008805 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008806}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00008807
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008808static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
8809 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008810 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008811 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008812
Yaron Keren4cd211b2017-02-22 14:32:39 +00008813 GVALinkage External;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008814 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
8815 case TSK_Undeclared:
8816 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8817 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8818 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008819
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008820 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008821 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008822
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00008823 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
8824 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
8825 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
8826 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
8827 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
8828 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008829 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008830 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8831
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008832 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008833 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008834 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008835 }
8836
8837 if (!FD->isInlined())
8838 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008839
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008840 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
8841 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008842 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00008843 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008844 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
8845
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008846 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
8847 // externally visible.
8848 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
8849 return External;
8850
8851 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008852 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008853 }
8854
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008855 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
8856 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
8857 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
David Majnemer73768702015-03-20 00:02:27 +00008858 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008859 return GVA_StrongODR;
8860
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008861 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008862}
8863
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008864static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext &Context,
8865 GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008866 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
8867 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
8868 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
8869 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
8870 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008871 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008872 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8873 return GVA_StrongODR;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008874 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice &&
8875 D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
8876 // Device-side functions with __global__ attribute must always be
8877 // visible externally so they can be launched from host.
8878 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_Internal)
8879 return GVA_StrongODR;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008880 }
8881 return L;
8882}
8883
8884GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00008885 auto L = adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008886 *this, basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD), FD);
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00008887 auto EK = ExternalASTSource::EK_ReplyHazy;
8888 if (auto *Ext = getExternalSource())
8889 EK = Ext->hasExternalDefinitions(FD->getOwningModuleID());
8890 switch (EK) {
8891 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Never:
8892 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8893 return GVA_StrongODR;
8894 break;
8895 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Always:
8896 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8897 case ExternalASTSource::EK_ReplyHazy:
8898 break;
8899 }
8900 return L;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008901}
8902
8903static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
8904 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008905 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
8906 return GVA_Internal;
8907
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008908 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008909 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
8910 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
8911 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
8912
David Blaikieeb210012017-01-27 23:11:10 +00008913 // ObjC Blocks can create local variables that don't have a FunctionDecl
8914 // LexicalContext.
8915 if (!LexicalContext)
8916 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008917
David Blaikieeb210012017-01-27 23:11:10 +00008918 // Otherwise, let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the
8919 // nearest enclosing function.
8920 auto StaticLocalLinkage =
8921 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
8922
8923 // Itanium ABI 5.2.2: "Each COMDAT group [for a static local variable] must
8924 // be emitted in any object with references to the symbol for the object it
8925 // contains, whether inline or out-of-line."
8926 // Similar behavior is observed with MSVC. An alternative ABI could use
8927 // StrongODR/AvailableExternally to match the function, but none are
8928 // known/supported currently.
8929 if (StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ||
8930 StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
8931 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8932 return StaticLocalLinkage;
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008933 }
8934
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00008935 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
8936 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
8937 // cause link errors.
8938 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8939 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8940
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00008941 // Most non-template variables have strong linkage; inline variables are
8942 // linkonce_odr or (occasionally, for compatibility) weak_odr.
8943 GVALinkage StrongLinkage;
8944 switch (Context.getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(VD)) {
8945 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None:
8946 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongExternal;
8947 break;
8948 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak:
8949 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008950 StrongLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00008951 break;
8952 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong:
8953 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongODR;
8954 break;
8955 }
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008956
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00008957 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008958 case TSK_Undeclared:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008959 return StrongLinkage;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008960
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008961 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00008962 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
8963 VD->isStaticDataMember()
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008964 ? GVA_StrongODR
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00008965 : StrongLinkage;
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00008966
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008967 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00008968 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008969
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008970 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8971 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8972
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00008973 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00008974 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008975 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00008976
8977 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008978}
8979
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008980GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00008981 return adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(
8982 *this, basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD), VD);
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00008983}
8984
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00008985bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D, bool ForModularCodegen) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00008986 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8987 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
8988 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00008989 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
8990 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
8991 return false;
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00008992 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
8993 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
8994 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00008995 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8996 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
8997 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
8998 return false;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00008999 } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D))
9000 return true;
Dmitry Polukhin0b0da292016-04-06 11:38:59 +00009001 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D) ||
9002 D->hasAttr<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr>())
9003 return true;
Nico Webercbbaeb12016-03-02 19:28:54 +00009004 else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D))
9005 return true;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00009006 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
Alexey Bataevc5b1d322016-03-04 09:22:22 +00009007 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
9008 else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D))
9009 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +00009010 else if (isa<ImportDecl>(D))
9011 return true;
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00009012 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00009013 return false;
9014
9015 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
9016 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009017 return false;
9018
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00009019 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
9020 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
9021 return false;
9022
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009023 // Aliases and used decls are required.
9024 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
9025 return true;
9026
9027 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
9028 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00009029 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00009030 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009031
9032 // Constructors and destructors are required.
9033 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
9034 return true;
9035
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00009036 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
9037 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
9038 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
9039 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
9040 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
9041 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
9042 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
9043 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
9044 return true;
9045 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009046 }
9047 }
9048
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009049 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
9050
9051 if (Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR && ForModularCodegen)
9052 return true;
9053
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009054 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
9055 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
9056 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009057 return !isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009058 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00009059
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009060 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
9061 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
9062
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00009063 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
9064 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00009065 return false;
9066
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009067 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Justin Lebar606f01f2016-10-13 20:52:17 +00009068 if (!isDiscardableGVALinkage(GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD)))
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009069 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009070
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009071 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
9072 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
9073 return true;
9074
9075 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00009076 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
Richard Smith187ffb42017-01-20 01:19:46 +00009077 // We can get a value-dependent initializer during error recovery.
9078 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue()))
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009079 return true;
9080
Richard Smithda383632016-08-15 01:33:41 +00009081 // Likewise, variables with tuple-like bindings are required if their
9082 // bindings have side-effects.
9083 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(VD))
9084 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
9085 if (auto *BindingVD = BD->getHoldingVar())
9086 if (DeclMustBeEmitted(BindingVD))
9087 return true;
9088
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009089 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009090}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00009091
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009092CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
9093 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00009094 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009095 if (IsCXXMethod)
9096 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00009097
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009098 switch (LangOpts.getDefaultCallingConv()) {
9099 case LangOptions::DCC_None:
9100 break;
9101 case LangOptions::DCC_CDecl:
9102 return CC_C;
9103 case LangOptions::DCC_FastCall:
9104 if (getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sse2"))
9105 return CC_X86FastCall;
9106 break;
9107 case LangOptions::DCC_StdCall:
9108 if (!IsVariadic)
9109 return CC_X86StdCall;
9110 break;
9111 case LangOptions::DCC_VectorCall:
9112 // __vectorcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
9113 if (!IsVariadic)
9114 return CC_X86VectorCall;
9115 break;
9116 }
Alexander Kornienko21de0ae2015-01-20 11:20:41 +00009117 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00009118}
9119
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00009120bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00009121 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
9122 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
9123}
9124
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00009125VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
9126 if (!VTContext.get()) {
9127 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9128 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
9129 else
9130 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
9131 }
9132 return VTContext.get();
9133}
9134
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009135MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009136 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00009137 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009138 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
9139 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +00009140 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009141 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00009142 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +00009143 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +00009144 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009145 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009146 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009147 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009148 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009149 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009150}
9151
Angel Garcia Gomez637d1e62015-10-20 13:23:58 +00009152CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009153
9154size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00009155 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
9156 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
9157 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
9158 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
9159 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
9160 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
9161 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
9162 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
9163 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
9164 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
9165 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
9166 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
9167 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
9168 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009169}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009170
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009171/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
9172/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
9173/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
9174/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9175QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
9176 unsigned Signed) const {
9177 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
9178 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
9179 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
9180 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
9181 return QualTy;
9182}
9183
9184/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
9185/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
9186/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9187QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
9188 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
9189 switch (Ty) {
9190 case TargetInfo::Float:
9191 return FloatTy;
9192 case TargetInfo::Double:
9193 return DoubleTy;
9194 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
9195 return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00009196 case TargetInfo::Float128:
9197 return Float128Ty;
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009198 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
9199 return QualType();
9200 }
9201
9202 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
9203}
9204
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009205void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
9206 if (Number > 1)
9207 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009208}
9209
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009210unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009211 auto I = MangleNumbers.find(ND);
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009212 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009213}
9214
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009215void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
9216 if (Number > 1)
9217 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
9218}
9219
9220unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009221 auto I = StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009222 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
9223}
9224
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009225MangleNumberingContext &
9226ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009227 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009228 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009229 if (!MCtx)
9230 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
9231 return *MCtx;
9232}
9233
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009234std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext>
9235ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009236 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00009237}
9238
David Majnemere7a818f2015-03-06 18:53:55 +00009239const CXXConstructorDecl *
9240ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
9241 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9242 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
9243}
9244
9245void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
9246 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
9247 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9248 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
9249 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
9250}
9251
David Majnemer00350522015-08-31 18:48:39 +00009252void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9253 TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
9254 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9255}
9256
9257TypedefNameDecl *
9258ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9259 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9260}
9261
9262void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9263 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
9264 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9265}
9266
9267DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9268 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9269}
9270
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009271void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
9272 ParamIndices[D] = index;
9273}
9274
9275unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
9276 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
9277 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
9278 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
9279 return I->second;
9280}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009281
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009282APValue *
9283ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
9284 bool MayCreate) {
9285 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
9286 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009287 if (MayCreate) {
9288 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
9289 if (!MTVI)
9290 MTVI = new (*this) APValue;
9291 return MTVI;
9292 }
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009293
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009294 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E);
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009295}
9296
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009297bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
9298 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
9299 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
9300 return false;
9301
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00009302 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
9303 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
9304 return false;
9305
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009306 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
9307 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
9308 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
9309 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
9310 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
9311 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
9312 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
9313}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009314
9315namespace {
9316
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009317ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(
9318 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers::mapped_type U) {
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009319 if (const auto *D = U.dyn_cast<const Decl *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009320 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*D);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009321 if (const auto *S = U.dyn_cast<const Stmt *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009322 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*S);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009323 return *U.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009324}
9325
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009326/// Template specializations to abstract away from pointers and TypeLocs.
9327/// @{
9328template <typename T>
9329ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const T &Node) {
9330 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node);
9331}
9332template <>
9333ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const TypeLoc &Node) {
9334 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9335}
9336template <>
9337ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode
9338createDynTypedNode(const NestedNameSpecifierLoc &Node) {
9339 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9340}
9341/// @}
9342
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009343 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
9344 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
9345 ///
9346 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
9347 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
9348 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
9349 ///
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009350 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009351 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009352 public:
9353 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
9354 ///
9355 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009356 static std::pair<ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *,
9357 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *>
9358 buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
9359 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMapPointers,
9360 new ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009361 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009362 return std::make_pair(Visitor.Parents, Visitor.OtherParents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009363 }
9364
9365 private:
9366 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
9367
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009368 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents,
9369 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents)
9370 : Parents(Parents), OtherParents(OtherParents) {}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009371
9372 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
9373 return true;
9374 }
9375 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
9376 return true;
9377 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009378
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009379 template <typename T, typename MapNodeTy, typename BaseTraverseFn,
9380 typename MapTy>
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009381 bool TraverseNode(T Node, MapNodeTy MapNode,
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009382 BaseTraverseFn BaseTraverse, MapTy *Parents) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00009383 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009384 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009385 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009386 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
9387 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
9388 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
9389 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
9390 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
9391 // new matches.
9392 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
9393 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
9394 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
9395 // do not have pointer identity.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009396 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[MapNode];
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009397 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009398 if (const auto *D = ParentStack.back().get<Decl>())
9399 NodeOrVector = D;
9400 else if (const auto *S = ParentStack.back().get<Stmt>())
9401 NodeOrVector = S;
9402 else
9403 NodeOrVector =
9404 new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009405 } else {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009406 if (!NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
9407 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(
9408 1, getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(NodeOrVector));
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009409 if (auto *Node =
9410 NodeOrVector
9411 .template dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>())
9412 delete Node;
Benjamin Kramer422b3ff2015-10-23 13:24:18 +00009413 NodeOrVector = Vector;
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009414 }
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009415
9416 auto *Vector =
9417 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
9418 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
9419 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
9420 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
9421 // types.
9422 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
9423 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
9424 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
9425 if (!Found)
9426 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009427 }
9428 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009429 ParentStack.push_back(createDynTypedNode(Node));
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009430 bool Result = BaseTraverse();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009431 ParentStack.pop_back();
9432 return Result;
9433 }
9434
9435 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009436 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, DeclNode,
9437 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseDecl(DeclNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009438 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009439 }
9440
9441 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009442 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, StmtNode,
9443 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseStmt(StmtNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009444 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009445 }
9446
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009447 bool TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLoc TypeLocNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009448 return TraverseNode(
9449 TypeLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(TypeLocNode),
9450 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLocNode); },
9451 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009452 }
9453
9454 bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLocNode) {
9455 return TraverseNode(
9456 NNSLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(NNSLocNode),
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009457 [&] {
9458 return VisitorBase::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NNSLocNode);
9459 },
9460 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009461 }
9462
9463 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents;
9464 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009465 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
9466
9467 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
9468 };
9469
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00009470} // anonymous namespace
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009471
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009472template <typename NodeTy, typename MapTy>
9473static ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList getDynNodeFromMap(const NodeTy &Node,
9474 const MapTy &Map) {
9475 auto I = Map.find(Node);
9476 if (I == Map.end()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009477 return llvm::ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009478 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009479 if (auto *V = I->second.template dyn_cast<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009480 return llvm::makeArrayRef(*V);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009481 }
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009482 return getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(I->second);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009483}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009484
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009485ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList
9486ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
9487 if (!PointerParents) {
9488 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
9489 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
9490 auto Maps = ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl());
9491 PointerParents.reset(Maps.first);
9492 OtherParents.reset(Maps.second);
9493 }
9494 if (Node.getNodeKind().hasPointerIdentity())
9495 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node.getMemoizationData(), *PointerParents);
9496 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node, *OtherParents);
9497}
9498
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009499bool
9500ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
9501 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
9502 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
9503 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
9504 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
9505 return false;
9506 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
9507 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9508 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00009509 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009510 return false;
9511
9512 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
9513 return false;
9514
9515 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
9516 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
9517 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
9518 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
9519 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
9520 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
9521 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9522 return false;
9523 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
9524 return false;
9525 }
9526 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
9527
9528}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009529
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009530uint64_t ASTContext::getTargetNullPointerValue(QualType QT) const {
9531 unsigned AS;
9532 if (QT->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()->isNullPtrType())
9533 AS = 0;
9534 else
9535 AS = QT->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
9536
9537 return getTargetInfo().getNullPointerValue(AS);
9538}
9539
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009540// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
9541// doesn't include ASTContext.h
9542template
9543clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9544 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
9545clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9546 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
9547 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);